blob: a2c72db05b83c2c8857d4e9e42e529cf93bda8b1 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau33205c22020-07-07 16:35:28 +02005 version 2.3
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Christopher Faulet10189c92021-01-13 16:10:29 +01007 2021/01/13
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand83972542020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200121
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012210. FastCGI applications
12310.1. Setup
12410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12510.1.2. Proxy section
12610.1.3. Example
12710.2. Default parameters
12810.3. Limitations
129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130
1311. Quick reminder about HTTP
132----------------------------
133
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
136on almost anything found in the contents.
137
138However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
139formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
140correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
141
142
1431.1. The HTTP transaction model
144-------------------------------
145
146The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100147to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100148from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
149connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150will involve a new connection :
151
152 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
153
154In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
155establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
156by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
157length.
158
159Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
160to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
161however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
162response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
163header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
168power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
169but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
174second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
175page :
176
177 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
178
179This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
180latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
181correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
182the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100183server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100185The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
186time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
187are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
188parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
189carry the stream identifier.
190
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
192connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
193leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
195processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
196waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200197
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200198HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100199 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
200 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100201 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206
2071.2. HTTP request
208-----------------
209
210First, let's consider this HTTP request :
211
212 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
215 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
216 3 User-agent: my small browser
217 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
218 5 Accept: image/png
219
220
2211.2.1. The Request line
222-----------------------
223
224Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
225
226 - a METHOD : GET
227 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
228 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
229
230All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
231which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
232followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
233is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
234desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
235the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
236
237The URI itself can have several forms :
238
239 - A "relative URI" :
240
241 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
244 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
245
246 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
247
248 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
251 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
252 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
253 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
254 must accept this form too.
255
256 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
257 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
258 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200260 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
261 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
262 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
263 other protocols too.
264
265In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
266mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
267on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
268It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
269specific to the language, framework or application in use.
270
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100271HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100272assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200274
2751.2.2. The request headers
276--------------------------
277
278The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
279beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
280an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
281Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
282values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
283encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
284the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
285define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100287Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100289"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200290as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
291normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
292representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
293HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
295The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
296that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
297is one valid form of empty line.
298
299Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
300headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
301about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
302application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
303
304Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000305 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
307 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
308 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
309
310
3111.3. HTTP response
312------------------
313
314An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
315messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
316
317 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100318 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
320 2 Content-length: 350
321 3 Content-Type: text/html
322
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200323As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
324codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
325response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100326continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
327the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
328following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
329sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
330(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
331correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
332such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
333state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
334over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
335if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
336information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200338
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003391.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340------------------------
341
342Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
343
344 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
345 - a status code : 200
346 - a reason : OK
347
348The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100349 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
350 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
351 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
352 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
353 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000355Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100356"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200357found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
358messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
359or "Authentication Required".
360
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362
363 Code When / reason
364 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
365 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
367 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100368 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370 400 for an invalid or too large request
371 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
372 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200373 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100374 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100376 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
377 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
379 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
380 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200381 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
383 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
384 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
385
386The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3874.2).
388
389
3901.3.2. The response headers
391---------------------------
392
393Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
394the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
395details.
396
397
3982. Configuring HAProxy
399----------------------
400
4012.1. Configuration file format
402------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200403
404HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
405
406 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100407 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombsdab4ba62021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700408 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100409 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100411The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
412a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
415
416 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
417
418 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
419 tab characters
420
421 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
422 keyword sequences listed in this document
423
424 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
425 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
426 parts of the configuration, or expressions
427
428 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
429 are supported
430
431 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
432 section
433
434This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
435generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
436figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
437
438First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
439the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
440a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
441word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
442follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
443the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
444the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
445the parts that need to be addressed.
446
447A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
448requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
449extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
450the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
451section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
452section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
453not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
454
455A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
456each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
457a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
458start a new one.
459
460Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
461that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
462applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
463"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
464processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
465ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
466which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
467In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
468of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
469identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
470such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4712, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
472
473 listen foo
474 bind :80
475
476 listen bar
477 bind :81
478
479Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
480spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
481of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
482following configurations are strictly equivalent:
483
484 global#this is the global section
485 daemon#daemonize
486 frontend foo
487 mode http # or tcp
488
489and:
490
491 global
492 daemon
493
494 # this is the public web frontend
495 frontend foo
496 mode http
497
498The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
499new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
500other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
501section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
502section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
503at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
504
505Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
506are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
507editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
508support automatic indent.
509
510In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
511positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
512modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
513anymore, and is not recommended.
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005162.2. Quoting and escaping
517-------------------------
518
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100519In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
520that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
521possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
522in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
523('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200524
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100525This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
526very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
527the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
528also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
529delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
530word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
531remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
534(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
535
536Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
537backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200538
539 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
540 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
541 \\ to use a backslash
542 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
543 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
544
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100545In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
546C-language representation:
547
548 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
549 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
550 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
551 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
552
553Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
554or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
555of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200556
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100557 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200558 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
559 # hash as a comment start
560
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100561Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
562evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
563dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
564backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200565
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
567character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
568is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200569
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
571entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
572name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
573represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
574hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200575
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100576 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
577 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
578 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
579 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
580 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
581 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
582 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
583 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
584 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
585 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
586 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200587
588 Example:
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100589 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
591 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
592 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
593 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
594 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
595
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
597necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
598by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
599they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
600escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
601characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
602case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
603if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
604own quotes.
605
606The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
607quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
608not always obvious is that the delimitors used inside must first be escaped or
609quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
610
611Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
612arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
613
614 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
615 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
616
617Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
618"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
619cannot write:
620
621 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
622
623because we would like the string to cut like this:
624
625 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
626 |---------|----|-|
627 arg1 _/ / /
628 arg2 __________/ /
629 arg3 ______________/
630
631but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
632parenthesis then garbage:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |--------|--------|
636 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
637 trailing garbage _________/
638
639The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
640quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
641processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
642this word:
643
644 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
645 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
646 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
647
648So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
649still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
650the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
651the second level:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
656 |---------||----|-|
657 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
658 arg2=blah ___________/ /
659 arg3=g _______________/
660
661Another approch consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
662double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
663
664 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
665 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
666 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
667 |---------||----|-|
668 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
669 arg2 ___________/ /
670 arg3 _______________/
671
672When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
673appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
674string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
675thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
676
677 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
678 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
679 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
680 |-------------| |-----||-|
681 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
682 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
683 arg3 ______________________/
684
685Remember that backslahes are not escape characters withing single quotes and
686that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
687quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
688single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
689level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
690
691When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
692double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
693and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
694a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
695a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
696the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
697regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
698around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
699more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200700
701
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007022.3. Environment variables
703--------------------------
704
705HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
706interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
707configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
708optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
709shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200710underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
711list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
712arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
713before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200714
715 Example:
716
717 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
718
719 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
720
721 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
722
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200723Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
724file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200725
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200726* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
727 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
728
729* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
730 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
731 directory.
732
733* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
734
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500735* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200736 processes, separated by semicolons.
737
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500738* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200739 CLI, separated by semicolons.
740
741See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200742
7432.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200744----------------
745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100746Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100747values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
748otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
749numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
750for every keyword. Supported units are :
751
752 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
753 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
754 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
755 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
756 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
757 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
758
759
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00007602.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200761-------------
762
763 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
764 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
765 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
766 global
767 daemon
768 maxconn 256
769
770 defaults
771 mode http
772 timeout connect 5000ms
773 timeout client 50000ms
774 timeout server 50000ms
775
776 frontend http-in
777 bind *:80
778 default_backend servers
779
780 backend servers
781 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
782
783
784 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
785 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
786 global
787 daemon
788 maxconn 256
789
790 defaults
791 mode http
792 timeout connect 5000ms
793 timeout client 50000ms
794 timeout server 50000ms
795
796 listen http-in
797 bind *:80
798 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
799
800
801Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
802
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100803 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200804
805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008063. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200807--------------------
808
809Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
810are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
811of them have command-line equivalents.
812
813The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
814
815 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200816 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200818 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200819 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200821 - description
822 - deviceatlas-json-file
823 - deviceatlas-log-level
824 - deviceatlas-separator
825 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900826 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200827 - gid
828 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100829 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200830 - h1-case-adjust
831 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100832 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100833 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100834 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200835 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200836 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200837 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100838 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200839 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100840 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200841 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200842 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200843 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200844 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200845 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200846 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100847 - presetenv
848 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200849 - uid
850 - ulimit-n
851 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200852 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100853 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200854 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200855 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200856 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200857 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200858 - ssl-default-bind-options
859 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200860 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200861 - ssl-default-server-options
862 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100863 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200864 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100865 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100866 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100867 - 51degrees-data-file
868 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200869 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200870 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200871 - wurfl-data-file
872 - wurfl-information-list
873 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200874 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100875 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100876
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200877 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100878 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200879 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200880 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200881 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100882 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100883 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100884 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200885 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200886 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200887 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200888 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200889 - noepoll
890 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000891 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200892 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100893 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300894 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000895 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100896 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200897 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200898 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200899 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000900 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000901 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200902 - tune.buffers.limit
903 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200904 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200905 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100906 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200907 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200908 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200909 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200910 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100911 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200912 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200913 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200914 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100915 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100916 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100917 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100918 - tune.lua.session-timeout
919 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200920 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100921 - tune.maxaccept
922 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200923 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200924 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200925 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200926 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
927 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100928 - tune.rcvbuf.client
929 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100930 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200931 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200932 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100933 - tune.sndbuf.client
934 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100935 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200936 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100937 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200938 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100939 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200940 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200941 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100942 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200943 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100944 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200945 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
946 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
947 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100948 - tune.zlib.memlevel
949 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100950
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200951 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200953 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200954
955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009563.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200957------------------------------------
958
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200959ca-base <dir>
960 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100961 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
962 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
963 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200964
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965chroot <jail dir>
966 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
967 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
968 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
969 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
970 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100972
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100973cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
974 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
975 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
976 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
977 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
978 set. These sets have the format
979
980 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
981
982 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100983 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100984 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
985 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100986 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
987 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100988 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100989 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100990 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100991 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100992 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
993 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
994 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
995 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100996
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100997 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
998 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
999 on the machine's word size.
1000
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001001 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001002 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1003 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1004 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1005 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1006 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1007 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001008
1009 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001010 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1011
1012 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1013 # first 4 CPUs
1014
1015 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1016 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1017 # word size.
1018
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001019 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001020 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001021 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1022 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1023 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1024
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001025 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1026 # and so on.
1027 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1028 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1029 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1030
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001031 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001032 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1033 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1034 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1035
1036 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1037 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1038 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1039
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001040 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1041 # and a thread range.
1042 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1043 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1044 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1045
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001046crt-base <dir>
1047 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001048 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1049 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001050
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001051daemon
1052 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1053 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001054 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1055 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001057deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1058 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001059 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001060
1061deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001062 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001063 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1064
1065deviceatlas-separator <char>
1066 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1067 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1068
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001069deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001070 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1071 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1072 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001073
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001074external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001075 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1076 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001077 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1078 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1079 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1080 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1081 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001082
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001083gid <number>
Thayne McCombsdab4ba62021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001084 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001085 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1086 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001087 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1088 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001089 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001090
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001091group <group name>
1092 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1093 See also "gid" and "user".
1094
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001095hard-stop-after <time>
1096 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1097
1098 Arguments :
1099 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1100 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1101 SIGUSR1 signal.
1102
1103 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1104 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1105 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1106
1107 Example:
1108 global
1109 hard-stop-after 30s
1110
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001111h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1112 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1113 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1114 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1115 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001116 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001117 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1118 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1119 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1120 specified in a proxy.
1121
1122 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1123 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1124 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1125 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1126 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1127 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1128 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1129
1130 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1131 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1132 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1133 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1134 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1135
1136 Example:
1137 global
1138 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1139
1140 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1141 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1142
1143h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1144 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1145 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1146 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1147 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1148 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1149 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1150 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1151 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1152
1153 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1154 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1155 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1156
1157 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1158 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1159
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001160insecure-fork-wanted
1161 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1162 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1163 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1164 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1165 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1166 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1167 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1168 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1169 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1170 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1171 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1172 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1173 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1174 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1175 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1176 disable it.
1177
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001178insecure-setuid-wanted
1179 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1180 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1181 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1182 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1183 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1184 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1185 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1186 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1187 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1188 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1189 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1190 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1191 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1192 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1193
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001194issuers-chain-path <dir>
1195 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1196 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1197 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1198 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1199 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1200 "issuers-chain-path".
1201 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1202 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1203 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1204 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1205 will share the chain in memory.
1206
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001207localpeer <name>
1208 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1209 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1210 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1211 the configuration parsing.
1212
1213 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1214 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1215
Jan Wagnerf2f5c4e2020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001216log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001217 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001218 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001219 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001220 configured with "log global".
1221
1222 <address> can be one of:
1223
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001224 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001225 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1226 port).
1227
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001228 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1229 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1230 port).
1231
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001232 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001233 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1234 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001235 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001236
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001237 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1238 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1239 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1240 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1241 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1242 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1243 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1244 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1245 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1246 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1247 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1248 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1249 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1250 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001251 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1252 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001253
1254 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1255 "fd@2", see above.
1256
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001257 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1258 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1259 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1260 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1261 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1262
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001263 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1264 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001265
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001266 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1267 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1268 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1269 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1270 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1271 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1272 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1273 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1274 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1275 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001276 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1277 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001278
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001279 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1280 one of the following :
1281
Emeric Bruna0338b92020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001282 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1283 field is stripped. This is the default.
1284 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1285 rfc3164.
1286
1287 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001288 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1289
1290 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1291 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1292
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001293 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1294 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1295 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1296 designed to be used with a local log server.
1297
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001298 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1299 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1300 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1301 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1302 logger consumes.
1303
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001304 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1305 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1306 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1307 used with a local log server.
1308
1309 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1310 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1311 designed to be used with a local log server.
1312
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001313 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1314 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1315 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1316 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1317
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001318 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1319 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1320 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1321 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1322 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1323
1324 <sample_size>
1325 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1326 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1327 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1328 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1329 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1330
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001331 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001332
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001333 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1334 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1335 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1336
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001337 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1338 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1339 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1340 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001341
1342 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001343 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1344 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1345 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1346 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1347 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1348 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001349
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001350 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001351
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001352log-send-hostname [<string>]
1353 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1354 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1355 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1356 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1357 the logs.
1358
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001359log-tag <string>
1360 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1361 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1362 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001363 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001364
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001365lua-load <file>
1366 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1367 used multiple times.
1368
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001369lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1370 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1371 variable.
1372 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1373 to "path".
1374
1375 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1376 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1377 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1378 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1379 will be checked earlier.
1380
1381 As an example by specifying the following path:
1382
1383 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1384 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1385
1386 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1387 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1388 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1389 paths if that does not exist either.
1390
1391 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1392 documentation.
1393
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001394master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001395 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1396 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1397 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001398 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001399 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1400 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001401 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1402 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1403 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1404 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1405 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001406
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001407 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001408
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001409mworker-max-reloads <number>
1410 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001411 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001412 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1413 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1414 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1415
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001416nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001417 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1418 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1419 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001420 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1421 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001422 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1423 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1424 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001425
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001426nbthread <number>
1427 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001428 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1429 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1430 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1431 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1432 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001433 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1434 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1435 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1436 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1437 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1438 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1439 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001440
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001441pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001442 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1443 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1444 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1445 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001446
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001447pp2-never-send-local
1448 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1449 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1450 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1451 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1452 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1453 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1454 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1455 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1456 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1457 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1458 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1459
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001460presetenv <name> <value>
1461 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1462 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1463 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1464 and "unsetenv".
1465
1466resetenv [<name> ...]
1467 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1468 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1469 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1470 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1471 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1472 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1473 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1474 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1475
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001476stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001477 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1478 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1479 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1480 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1481 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1482 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001483 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001484 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1485 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1486 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1487 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001488
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001489server-state-base <directory>
1490 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001491 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1492 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001493
1494server-state-file <file>
1495 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1496 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1497 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1498 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1499 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1500 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1501 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1502 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001503 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1504 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001505
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001506setenv <name> <value>
1507 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1508 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1509 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1510 and "unsetenv".
1511
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001512set-dumpable
1513 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001514 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1515 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1516 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1517 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1518 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1519 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1520 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1521 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1522 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1523 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1524 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1525 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1526 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1527 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1528 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1529 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1530 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001531
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001532ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1533 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1534 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001535 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001536 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001537 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1538 information and recommendations see e.g.
1539 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1540 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1541 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1542 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001543
1544ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1545 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1546 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1547 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1548 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1549 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001550 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1551 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1552 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001553 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001554
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001555ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1556 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1557 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1558 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1559 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1560 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1561
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001562ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1563 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1564 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1565 keyword to see available options.
1566
1567 Example:
1568 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001569 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001570
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001571ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1572 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1573 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001574 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001575 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001576 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1577 information and recommendations see e.g.
1578 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1579 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1580 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1581 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1582 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001583
1584ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1585 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1586 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1587 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1588 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1589 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001590 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1591 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1592 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1593 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001594
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001595ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1596 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1597 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1598 keyword to see available options.
1599
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001600ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1601 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1602 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1603 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001604 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001605 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001606 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1607 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1608 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1609 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001610 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1611 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1612 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1613
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001614ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1615 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1616 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001617 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001618 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001619 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1620
1621 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001622
1623 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1624 and won't try to remove them.
1625
1626 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1627
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001628ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001629 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001630 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1631 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001632
1633 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1634 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1635 optimize the startup time.
1636
1637 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1638 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1639 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1640
1641 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001642 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001643
1644 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001645 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1646
1647 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1648 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1649 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1650 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1651 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1652 bind configuration..
1653
1654 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1655 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1656 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1657 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1658 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1659 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1660 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1661 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1662
1663 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1664
1665 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1666 a cert bundle.
1667
1668 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1669 separately in several "crt".
1670
1671 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1672 since files are loading separately.
1673
1674 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1675 required to commit them.
1676
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001677 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001678 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001679
1680 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1681
1682 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1683
1684 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1685 not provided in the PEM file.
1686
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001687 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1688 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1689
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001690 The default behavior is "all".
1691
1692 Example:
1693 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1694 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1695 ssl-load-extra-files none
1696
1697 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1698
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001699ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1700 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1701 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1702 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1703
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001704ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001705 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001706 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1707 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1708 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1709 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1710 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1711 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001712 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001713
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001714stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1715 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1716 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1717 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001718 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001719 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001720
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001721 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1722 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1723 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001724
1725stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1726 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1727 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001728 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001729
1730stats maxconn <connections>
1731 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1732 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1733
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001734uid <number>
Thayne McCombsdab4ba62021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001735 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001736 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1737 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1738 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1739
1740ulimit-n <number>
1741 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1742 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1743 option.
1744
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001745unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1746 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1747
1748 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1749 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1750 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1751 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1752 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1753 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1754 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1755 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1756 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1757 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1758
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001759unsetenv [<name> ...]
1760 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1761 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1762 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1763 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1764 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1765 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1766 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1767
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001768user <user name>
1769 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1770 See also "uid" and "group".
1771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001772node <name>
1773 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1774
1775 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1776 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1777 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1778 traffic.
1779
1780description <text>
1781 Add a text that describes the instance.
1782
1783 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1784 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1785 "<" and ">" characters.
1786
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100178751degrees-data-file <file path>
1788 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001789 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001790
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001791 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001792 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1793
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000179451degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001795 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1796 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1797 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1798
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001799 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001800 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1801
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200180251degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001803 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1804 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1805
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001806 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1807 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1808
180951degrees-cache-size <number>
1810 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1811 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1812 By default, this cache is disabled.
1813
1814 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001815 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1816
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001817wurfl-data-file <file path>
1818 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1819 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1820
1821 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1822 with USE_WURFL=1.
1823
1824wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1825 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1826 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1827 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1828
1829 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1830
1831 Valid WURFL properties are:
1832 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1833
1834 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1835 device.
1836
1837 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1838 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1839
1840 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1841 particular web request.
1842
1843 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1844 used Libwurfl API version.
1845
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001846 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1847 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1848
1849 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1850 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1851
1852 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1853
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001854 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1855 with USE_WURFL=1.
1856
1857wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1858 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1859 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1860
1861 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1862 with USE_WURFL=1.
1863
1864wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1865 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1866 thus before the chroot.
1867
1868 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1869 with USE_WURFL=1.
1870
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001871wurfl-cache-size <size>
1872 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1873 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001874 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001875 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001876
1877 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1878 with USE_WURFL=1.
1879
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001880strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001881 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1882 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1883 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1884 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1885 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001886
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018873.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001888-----------------------
1889
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001890busy-polling
1891 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1892 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1893 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1894 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1895 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1896 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1897 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1898 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1899 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1900 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1901 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1902 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1903 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1904 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1905 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1906 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1907 "poll" pollers.
1908
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001909 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1910 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1911 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1912
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001913max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1914 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1915 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1916 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1917 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1918 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1919 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1920 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1921 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1922
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001923maxconn <number>
1924 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1925 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1926 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001927 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1928 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1929 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1930 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001931 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1932 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1933 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1934 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1935 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1936 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001937
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001938maxconnrate <number>
1939 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1940 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1941 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1942 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1943 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1944 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1945 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1946 fairness.
1947
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001948maxcomprate <number>
1949 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001950 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001951 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1952 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1953 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001954 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001955 default value.
1956
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001957maxcompcpuusage <number>
1958 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1959 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1960 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1961 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1962 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1963 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1964 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1965 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1966
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001967maxpipes <number>
1968 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1969 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1970 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1971 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1972 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1973 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1974
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001975maxsessrate <number>
1976 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1977 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1978 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1979 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1980 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1981 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1982 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1983 fairness.
1984
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001985maxsslconn <number>
1986 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1987 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1988 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1989 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1990 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1991 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1992 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001993 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1994 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1995 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1996 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1997 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1998 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1999 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002000
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002001maxsslrate <number>
2002 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2003 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2004 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2005 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2006 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2007 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2008 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2009 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2010 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2011 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2012
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002013maxzlibmem <number>
2014 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2015 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2016 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002017 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2018 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2019 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2020
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002021noepoll
2022 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2023 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002024 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002025
2026nokqueue
2027 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2028 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2029 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2030
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002031noevports
2032 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2033 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2034 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2035 also "nopoll".
2036
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002037nopoll
2038 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2039 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002040 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002041 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2042 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002043
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002044nosplice
2045 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002046 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002047 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002048 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002049 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2050 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2051 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2052 "option splice-response".
2053
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002054nogetaddrinfo
2055 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2056 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2057
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002058noreuseport
2059 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2060 command line argument "-dR".
2061
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002062profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2063 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2064 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2065 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2066 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002067 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002068 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2069 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2070 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2071 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2072
2073 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2074 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2075 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2076 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2077 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002078 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2079 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2080 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2081 CLI.
2082
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002083spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002084 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2085 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2086 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2087 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2088 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2089 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002090
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002091ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002092 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002093 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002094 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2095 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2096 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2097 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2098 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002099 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2100 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002101 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2102 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2103 openssl configuration file uses:
2104 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2105
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002106ssl-mode-async
2107 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002108 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002109 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2110 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2111 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002112 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002113 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002114
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002115tune.buffers.limit <number>
2116 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2117 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2118 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2119 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2120 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002121 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002122 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2123 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2124 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2125 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2126 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2127 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2128 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2129 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2130 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2131
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002132tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2133 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2134 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2135 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2136 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2137
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002138tune.bufsize <number>
2139 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2140 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2141 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2142 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2143 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2144 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2145 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002146 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2147 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2148 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002149 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002150 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2151 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2152 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002153
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002154tune.chksize <number>
2155 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
2156 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
2157 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
2158 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
2159 checks whenever possible.
2160
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002161tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2162 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2163 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2164 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2165 this value. The default value is 1.
2166
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002167tune.fail-alloc
2168 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2169 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2170 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2171 gracefully.
2172
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002173tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2174 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2175 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2176 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2177 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2178 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2179
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002180tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2181 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2182 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2183 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2184 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2185 change it.
2186
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002187tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2188 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002189 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2190 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002191 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2192 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2193 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2194 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2195 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2196
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002197tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2198 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2199 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2200 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2201 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2202 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2203 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2204 recommended not to change this value.
2205
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002206tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2207 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2208 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2209 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2210 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2211 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2212 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2213 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2214
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002215tune.http.cookielen <number>
2216 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2217 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2218 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2219 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2220 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2221 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2222 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2223 to change this value.
2224
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002225tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002226 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2227 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002228 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002229 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002230 configuration directives too.
2231 The default value is 1024.
2232
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002233tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2234 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2235 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2236 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2237 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2238 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2239 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002240 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2241 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2242 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002243
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002244tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2245 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2246 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2247 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2248 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2249 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2250 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
2251 this option to "off". The default is on.
2252
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002253tune.idletimer <timeout>
2254 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2255 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2256 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2257 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2258 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2259 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002260 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002261 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002262 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2263
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002264tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2265 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2266 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2267 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2268 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2269 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2270 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2271 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2272 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2273 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2274
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002275tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2276 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002277 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002278 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2279 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002280 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002281 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2282 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2283
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002284tune.lua.maxmem
2285 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2286 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2287 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2288 memory.
2289
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002290tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2291 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002292 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2293 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002294 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002295
2296tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2297 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2298 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2299 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2300 check servers.
2301
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002302tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2303 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2304 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2305 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002306 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002307
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002308tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002309 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2310 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2311 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2312 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2313 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2314 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2315 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2316 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2317 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2318 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002319
2320tune.maxpollevents <number>
2321 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2322 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2323 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2324 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2325 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2326
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002327tune.maxrewrite <number>
2328 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2329 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2330 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2331 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2332 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2333 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2334 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2335 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2336 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2337 bufsize.
2338
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002339tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2340 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2341 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2342 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2343 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2344 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2345 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2346 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2347 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2348 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002349 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2350 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002351 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2352 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2353 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2354 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2355 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2356 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2357 setting this parameter to 0.
2358
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002359tune.pipesize <number>
2360 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2361 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2362 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2363 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2364 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2365 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2366
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002367tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2368 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2369 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2370 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2371 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2372 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2373 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002374 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002375
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002376tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2377 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2378 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2379 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2380 default is 20.
2381
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002382tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2383tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2384 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2385 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2386 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002387 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002388 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002389 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2390 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2391
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002392tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002393 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002394 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2395 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2396 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2397 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2398
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002399tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002400 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002401 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002402 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2403 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2404 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2405
2406tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2407 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2408 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2409 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2410 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2411 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2412 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2413 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2414 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2415 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002416
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002417tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2418tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2419 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2420 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2421 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002422 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002423 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002424 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2425 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2426 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2427 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2428 notifying haproxy again.
2429
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002430tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002431 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2432 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2433 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002434 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002435 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002436 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002437 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2438 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2439 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002440 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2441 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002442
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002443tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002444 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002445 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2446 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2447 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2448 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2449 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2450
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002451tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2452 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2453 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2454 performances. This is disabled by default.
2455
2456 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2457 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2458
2459 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2460
2461 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2462
2463 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2464
2465 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2466 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2467 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2468
2469 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2470 converted.
2471
2472 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2473 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2474 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2475 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2476 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2477 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2478 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002479 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2480 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002481
2482 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2483
2484 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2485 only need this line:
2486
2487 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2488
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002489tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2490 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002491 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002492 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2493 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2494 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2495 being used for too long.
2496
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002497tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2498 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2499 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2500 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2501 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2502 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2503 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2504 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2505 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2506 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2507 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002508 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002509 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002510
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002511tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2512 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2513 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2514 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2515 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002516 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002517 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2518 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002519 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2520 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002521
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002522tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2523 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2524 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2525 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2526 1000 entries.
2527
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002528tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2529 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2530 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2531 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2532
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002533tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002534tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002535tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2536tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2537tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002538 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2539 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2540 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2541 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2542 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2543 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2544 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2545 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002546
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002547 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2548 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2549 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2550 all available space is consumed.
2551 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2552 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2553 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002554
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002555tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2556 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002557 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002558 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002559 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002560 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2561
2562tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2563 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2564 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002565 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2566 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025683.3. Debugging
2569--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002570
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002571quiet
2572 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2573 line argument "-q".
2574
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002575zero-warning
2576 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2577 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2578 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2579 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2580 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2581 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2582
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002583
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010025843.4. Userlists
2585--------------
2586It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2587http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2588it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2589
2590userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002591 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002592 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2593
2594group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002595 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002596 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2597 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2598
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002599user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2600 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002601 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2602 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002603 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2604 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2605 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2606 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002607
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002608 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2609 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2610 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2611 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2612 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2613 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2614 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2615 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2616 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002617
2618 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002619 userlist L1
2620 group G1 users tiger,scott
2621 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002622
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002623 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2624 user scott insecure-password elgato
2625 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002626
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002627 userlist L2
2628 group G1
2629 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002630
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002631 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2632 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2633 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002634
2635 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002636
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002637
26383.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002639----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002640It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2641several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2642instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2643values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2644automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2645In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2646using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2647tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2648reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2649Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2650that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2651each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002652
2653peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002654 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002655 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2656
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002657bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2658 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2659 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2660
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002661disabled
2662 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2663 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2664 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2665
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002666default-bind [param*]
2667 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2668
2669default-server [param*]
2670 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2671
2672 Arguments:
2673 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2674 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2675 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2676 details.
2677
2678
2679 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2680
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002681enable
2682 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2683
Jan Wagnerf2f5c4e2020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002684log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002685 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2686 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2687 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2688 more details.
2689
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002690peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002691 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2692 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002693 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2694 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2695 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2696 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2697 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002698
2699 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2700 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2701
2702 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002703 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2704 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2705 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002706
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002707 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2708 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002709
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002710 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2711 "server" keyword explanation below).
2712
2713server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002714 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002715 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2716 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2717 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2718 of this "peers" section).
2719 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2720
2721
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002722 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002723 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002724 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002725 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2726 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2727 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002728
2729 backend mybackend
2730 mode tcp
2731 balance roundrobin
2732 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2733 stick on src
2734
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002735 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2736 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002737
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002738 Example:
2739 peers mypeers
2740 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2741 default-server ssl verify none
2742 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2743 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002744
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002745
2746table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2747 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2748
2749 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2750 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002751 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002752 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2753 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2754 "stick-table" keyword).
2755
2756 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2757 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2758 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2759 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2760 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2761 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2762 of the stick-table name as follows:
2763
2764 peers mypeers
2765 peer A ...
2766 peer B ...
2767 table t1 ...
2768
2769 frontend fe1
2770 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2771
2772 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2773 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2774
2775 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2776 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2777 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2778 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2779 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2780 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2781 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2782
2783 peers mypeers
2784 peer A ...
2785 peer B ...
2786 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2787
2788 backend t1
2789 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2790
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002791 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002792 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2793 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2794
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090027953.6. Mailers
2796------------
2797It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2798If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2799in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2800
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002801mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002802 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2803 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2804
2805mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2806 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2807
2808 Example:
2809 mailers mymailers
2810 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2811 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2812
2813 backend mybackend
2814 mode tcp
2815 balance roundrobin
2816
2817 email-alert mailers mymailers
2818 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2819 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2820
2821 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2822 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2823
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002824timeout mail <time>
2825 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2826 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2827 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2828 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2829
2830 Example:
2831 mailers mymailers
2832 timeout mail 20s
2833 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002834
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020028353.7. Programs
2836-------------
2837In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2838master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2839managed the same way as the workers.
2840
2841During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2842sequence as a worker:
2843
2844 - the master is re-executed
2845 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2846 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2847 instance of the program
2848
2849During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2850
2851program <name>
2852 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2853 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2854 the management guide).
2855
2856command <command> [arguments*]
2857 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2858 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2859 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2860 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2861
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002862user <user name>
2863 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2864 See also "group".
2865
2866group <group name>
2867 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2868 See also "user".
2869
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002870option start-on-reload
2871no option start-on-reload
2872 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2873 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2874 program section.
2875
2876
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010028773.8. HTTP-errors
2878----------------
2879
2880It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2881imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2882several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2883
2884http-errors <name>
2885 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2886 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2887
2888errorfile <code> <file>
2889 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2890
2891 Arguments :
2892 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002893 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2894 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002895
2896 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2897 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2898 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2899 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2900 before any chroot is performed.
2901
2902 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2903
2904 Example:
2905 http-errors website-1
2906 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2907 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2908 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2909
2910 http-errors website-2
2911 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2912 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2913 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2914
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020029153.9. Rings
2916----------
2917
2918It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2919servers or traces.
2920
2921ring <ringname>
2922 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2923
2924description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002925 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002926 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2927
2928format <format>
2929 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2930
2931 Arguments:
2932 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2933 one of the following :
2934
2935 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2936 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2937 designed to be used with a local log server.
2938
Emeric Bruna0338b92020-11-27 16:24:34 +01002939 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
2940 field is stripped. This is the default.
2941 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
2942 rfc3164.
2943
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002944 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2945 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2946 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2947 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2948 is the default.
2949
Emeric Bruna0338b92020-11-27 16:24:34 +01002950 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002951 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2952
2953 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2954 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2955
2956 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2957 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2958 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2959 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2960 logger consumes.
2961
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002962 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2963 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2964 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2965 with a local log server.
2966
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002967 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2968 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2969 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2970 used with a local log server.
2971
2972maxlen <length>
2973 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2974 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2975 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2976
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002977server <name> <address> [param*]
2978 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2979 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2980 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2981 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2982 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2983 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2984 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2985 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2986 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002987 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2988 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002989
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002990size <size>
2991 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2992 set to BUFSIZE.
2993
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002994timeout connect <timeout>
2995 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2996
2997 Arguments :
2998 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2999 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3000 as explained at the top of this document.
3001
3002timeout server <timeout>
3003 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3004
3005 Arguments :
3006 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3007 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3008 as explained at the top of this document.
3009
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003010 Example:
3011 global
3012 log ring@myring local7
3013
3014 ring myring
3015 description "My local buffer"
3016 format rfc3164
3017 maxlen 1200
3018 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003019 timeout connect 5s
3020 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003021 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003022
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020030233.10. Log forwarding
3024-------------------
3025
3026It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3027haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3028
3029log-forward <name>
3030 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3031
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003032backlog <conns>
3033 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3034 on connections accept.
3035
3036bind <addr> [param*]
3037 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003038 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3039 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3040 syslog protocol over TCP.
3041 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003042 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3043
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003044dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003045 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3046 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3047 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3048 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003049 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003050
3051log global
Jan Wagnerf2f5c4e2020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003052log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003053 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3054 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3055 documentation.
3056 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3057 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3058 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3059 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3060 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3061
3062 Example:
3063 global
3064 log stderr format iso local7
3065
3066 ring myring
3067 description "My local buffer"
3068 format rfc5424
3069 maxlen 1200
3070 size 32764
3071 timeout connect 5s
3072 timeout server 10s
3073 # syslog tcp server
3074 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3075
3076 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003077 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3078 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003079 # all messages on stderr
3080 log global
3081 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3082 log ring@myring local0
3083 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3084 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3085 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3086 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3087 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003088
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003089maxconn <conns>
3090 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3091 10 is the default.
3092
3093timeout client <timeout>
3094 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020030964. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003097----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003098
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003099Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02003100 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003101 - frontend <name>
3102 - backend <name>
3103 - listen <name>
3104
3105A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
3106its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
3107section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003108section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003109
3110A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3111connections.
3112
3113A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3114to forward incoming connections.
3115
3116A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3117parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3118
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003119All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3120'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3121case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3122
3123Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3124logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3125proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3126However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3127name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3128
3129Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3130and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003131bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003132protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3133modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3134arbitrary criteria.
3135
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003136In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3137a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003138the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003139
3140 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3141 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3142 between responses and new requests.
3143
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003144 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3145 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3146 client-facing connection remains open.
3147
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003148 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3149 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003150
3151The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3152frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3153following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003154weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003155
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003156 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003157
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003158 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3159 ----+-----+-----+----
3160 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3161 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003162 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3163 ----+-----+-----+----
3164 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003165
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003166
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003167
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031684.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3169--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003171The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3172limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3173they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3174limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003175marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003176option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003177and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3178with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3179specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003180
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003181
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003182 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3183------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3184acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003185backlog X X X -
3186balance X - X X
3187bind - X X -
3188bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003189capture cookie - X X -
3190capture request header - X X -
3191capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003192clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3193clitcpka-idle X X X -
3194clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003195compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003196cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003197declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003198default-server X - X X
3199default_backend X X X -
3200description - X X X
3201disabled X X X X
3202dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003203email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003204email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003205email-alert mailers X X X X
3206email-alert myhostname X X X X
3207email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003208enabled X X X X
3209errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003210errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003211errorloc X X X X
3212errorloc302 X X X X
3213-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3214errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003215force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003216filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003217fullconn X - X X
3218grace X X X X
3219hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003220http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003221http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003222http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003223http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003224http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003225http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003226http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003227http-check set-var X - X X
3228http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003229http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003230http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003231http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003232http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003233http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003234id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003235ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003236load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003237log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003238log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003239log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003240log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003241max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003242maxconn X X X -
3243mode X X X X
3244monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003245monitor-uri X X X -
3246option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3247option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3248option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3249option allbackups (*) X - X X
3250option checkcache (*) X - X X
3251option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3252option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003253option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003254option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3255option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003256-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3257option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003258option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3259option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003260option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003261option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003262option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003263option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003264option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003265option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3266option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3267option httpchk X - X X
3268option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003269option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003270option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003271option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003272option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003273option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003274option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3275option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3276option logasap (*) X X X -
3277option mysql-check X - X X
3278option nolinger (*) X X X X
3279option originalto X X X X
3280option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003281option pgsql-check X - X X
3282option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003283option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003284option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003285option smtpchk X - X X
3286option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3287option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3288option splice-request (*) X X X X
3289option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003290option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003291option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3292option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3293-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003294option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003295option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3296option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3297option tcpka X X X X
3298option tcplog X X X X
3299option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003300external-check command X - X X
3301external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003302persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3303rate-limit sessions X X X -
3304redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003305-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003306retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003307retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003308server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003309server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003310server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003311source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003312srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3313srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3314srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003315stats admin - X X X
3316stats auth X X X X
3317stats enable X X X X
3318stats hide-version X X X X
3319stats http-request - X X X
3320stats realm X X X X
3321stats refresh X X X X
3322stats scope X X X X
3323stats show-desc X X X X
3324stats show-legends X X X X
3325stats show-node X X X X
3326stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003327-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3328stick match - - X X
3329stick on - - X X
3330stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003331stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003332stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003333tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003334tcp-check connect X - X X
3335tcp-check expect X - X X
3336tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003337tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003338tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003339tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003340tcp-check set-var X - X X
3341tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003342tcp-request connection - X X -
3343tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003344tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003345tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003346tcp-response content - - X X
3347tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003348timeout check X - X X
3349timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003350timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003351timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003352timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3353timeout http-request X X X X
3354timeout queue X - X X
3355timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003356timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003357timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003358timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003359transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003360unique-id-format X X X -
3361unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003362use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003363use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003364use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003365------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3366 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003367
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003368
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033694.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3370---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003371
3372This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3373
3374
3375acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3376 Declare or complete an access list.
3377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3378 no | yes | yes | yes
3379 Example:
3380 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3381 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3382 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3383
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003384 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003385
3386
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003387backlog <conns>
3388 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3390 yes | yes | yes | no
3391 Arguments :
3392 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3393 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003394 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003395
3396 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3397 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3398 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3399 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3400 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3401 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3402 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3403 backlog parameter.
3404
3405 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3406 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3407 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3408
3409 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3410
3411
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003412balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003413balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003414 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3416 yes | no | yes | yes
3417 Arguments :
3418 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3419 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3420 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3421 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3422
3423 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3424 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3425 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3426 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003427 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003428 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003429 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3430 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3431 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3432 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3433 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3434 it, so that you don't worry.
3435
3436 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3437 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3438 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3439 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3440 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3441 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3442 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3443 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003444
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003445 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3446 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3447 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3448 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3449 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3450 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3451 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003452 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3453 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3454 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003455
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003456 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003457 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003458 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3459 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003460 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003461 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3462 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3463 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3464 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3465 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003466 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3467 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3468 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3469 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3470 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3471 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003472
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003473 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3474 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3475 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3476 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3477 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3478 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3479 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3480 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003481 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003482 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003483 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3484 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3485 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003486
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003487 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3488 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3489 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3490 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3491 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3492 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3493 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3494 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3495 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3496 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3497 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3498 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003499
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003500 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003501 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3502 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3503 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3504 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3505 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3506 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3507 URIs start with a leading "/".
3508
3509 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3510 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3511 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3512 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3513
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003514 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3515 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3516 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3517 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3518
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003519 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003520 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3521
3522 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003523 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3524 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003525 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3526 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3527 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3528 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003529 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003530 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3531 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003532
3533 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3534 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3535 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3536 server will receive the request.
3537
3538 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3539 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3540 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3541 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3542 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003543 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3544 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3545 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003546
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003547 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3548 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3549 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3550 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3551 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003552
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003553 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003554 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3555 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3556 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3557
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003558 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3559 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3560 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3561
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003562 random
3563 random(<draws>)
3564 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003565 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3566 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3567 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3568 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003569 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3570 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3571 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3572 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3573 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3574 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3575 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3576 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3577 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3578 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3579 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3580 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3581 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3582 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3583 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3584 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3585 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3586 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3587 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3588 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003589
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003590 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003591 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003592 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3593 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3594 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3595 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3596 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3597 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003598 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003599 used instead.
3600
3601 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3602 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3603 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3604 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3605
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003606 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3607 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3608 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3609
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003610 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003611
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003612 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003613 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3614 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003615
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003616 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3617 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3618 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003619
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003620 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003621 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003622 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3623 NTLM relies on.
3624
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003625 Examples :
3626 balance roundrobin
3627 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003628 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003629 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3630 balance hdr(host)
3631 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003632
3633 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3634 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3635
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003636 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003637 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3638 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3639 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003640 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003641
3642 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3643 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3644 defaults to 16 kB.
3645
3646 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3647 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3648
3649 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3650 Round Robin.
3651
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003652 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003653 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3654 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3655 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3656
3657 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3658
3659 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003660 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003661 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3662 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3663 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003664
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003665 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003666
3667
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003668bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3669bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003670 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3672 no | yes | yes | no
3673 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003674 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3675 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3676 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3677 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003678 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003679 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3680 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3681 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3682 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3683 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3684 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003685 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003686 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3687 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003688 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003689 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3690 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003691 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003692 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3693 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003694 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003695 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3696 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3697 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3698 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3699 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3700 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3701 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003702 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3703 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3704 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003705 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3706 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3707 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3708 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003709 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3710 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3711 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003712
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003713 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3714 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003715 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3716 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3717 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003718 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3719 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3720 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3721 the range.
3722
3723 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3724 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3725 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3726 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3727 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3728 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3729 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003730 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003731 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003732
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003733 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003734 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003735 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3736 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3737 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3738 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3739 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3740 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3741
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003742 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3743 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3744 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3745 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003746
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003747 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3748 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3749 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3750 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3751 in a frontend.
3752
3753 Example :
3754 listen http_proxy
3755 bind :80,:443
3756 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003757 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003758
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003759 listen http_https_proxy
3760 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003761 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003762
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003763 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3764 bind ipv6@:80
3765 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3766 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3767
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003768 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003769 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003770
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003771 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3772 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3773 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3774 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3775 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3776
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003777 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003778 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003779
3780
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003781bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003782 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3784 yes | yes | yes | yes
3785 Arguments :
3786 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3787 may be used to override a default value.
3788
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003789 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003790 option may be combined with other numbers.
3791
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003792 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003793 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3794 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3795 missing from all processes.
3796
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003797 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003798 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003799 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3800 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3801 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3802 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3803 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003804 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003805
3806 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3807 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3808 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3809 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3810 and 'even' instances.
3811
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003812 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3813 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3814 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3815 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003816
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003817 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3818 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3819
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003820 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3821 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3822 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3823
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003824 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3825 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3826
3827 Example :
3828 listen app_ip1
3829 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003830 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003831
3832 listen app_ip2
3833 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003834 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003835
3836 listen management
3837 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003838 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003839
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003840 listen management
3841 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3842 bind-process 1-4
3843
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003844 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003845
3846
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003847capture cookie <name> len <length>
3848 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3850 no | yes | yes | no
3851 Arguments :
3852 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3853 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3854 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3855 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003856 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003857
3858 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3859 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3860 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3861 right if it exceeds <length>.
3862
3863 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3864 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3865 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3866 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3867
3868 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3869 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3870 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3871
3872 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3873 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3874 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003875 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3876 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3877 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003878
3879 Example:
3880 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3881
3882 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003883 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003884
3885
3886capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003887 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3889 no | yes | yes | no
3890 Arguments :
3891 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003892 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003893 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3894 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3895 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3896
3897 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3898 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3899 it exceeds <length>.
3900
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003901 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003902 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3903 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003904 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3905 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3906 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3907 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003908 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003909 environments to find where the request came from.
3910
3911 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3912 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3913 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3914 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003915
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003916 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3917 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3918 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3919 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3920 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003921
3922 Example:
3923 capture request header Host len 15
3924 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003925 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003927 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003928 about logging.
3929
3930
3931capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003932 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3934 no | yes | yes | no
3935 Arguments :
3936 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003937 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003938 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3939 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3940 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3941
3942 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3943 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3944 it exceeds <length>.
3945
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003946 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003947 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3948 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3949 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003950 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3951 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3952 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3953 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003954
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003955 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3956 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3957 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3958 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3959 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003960
3961 Example:
3962 capture response header Content-length len 9
3963 capture response header Location len 15
3964
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003965 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003966 about logging.
3967
3968
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003969clitcpka-cnt <count>
3970 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3971 the connection on the client side.
3972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3973 yes | yes | yes | no
3974 Arguments :
3975 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3976
3977 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3978 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003979 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3980 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003981
3982 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3983
3984
3985clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3986 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3987 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3988 client side.
3989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3990 yes | yes | yes | no
3991 Arguments :
3992 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3993 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3994 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
3995 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
3996
3997 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
3998 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003999 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4000 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004001
4002 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4003
4004
4005clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4006 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4008 yes | yes | yes | no
4009 Arguments :
4010 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4011 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4012 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4013 document.
4014
4015 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4016 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004017 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4018 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004019
4020 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4021
4022
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004023compression algo <algorithm> ...
4024compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004025compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004026 Enable HTTP compression.
4027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4028 yes | yes | yes | yes
4029 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004030 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4031 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4032 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4033
4034 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004035 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4036 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4037 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004038
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004039 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004040 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004041
4042 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4043 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4044 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4045 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4046 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004047 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004048
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004049 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4050 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4051 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4052 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4053 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4054 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4055 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004056 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004057
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004058 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004059 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004060 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4061 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4062 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4063 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4064 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004065
4066 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4067 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4068 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4069 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4070 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004071 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4072 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4073 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4074 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4075 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004076 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4077 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004078
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004079 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004080 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4081 "Accept-Encoding" header
4082 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004083 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004084 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4085 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4086 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4087 "multipart"
4088 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4089 header
4090 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4091 and later
4092 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4093 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004094 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004095
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004096 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004097
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004098 Examples :
4099 compression algo gzip
4100 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004101
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004102
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004103cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004104 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4105 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004106 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004107 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4109 yes | no | yes | yes
4110 Arguments :
4111 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4112 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4113 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4114 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4115 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4116 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004117 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004118 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4119 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4120
4121 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4122 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4123 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4124 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4125 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4126 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004127 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4128 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004129 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004130 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4131 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004132
4133 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004134 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004135
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004136 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004137 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004138 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004139 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004140 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4141 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4142 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4143 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4144 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4145 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4146 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004147
4148 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4149 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4150 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4151 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4152 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4153 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4154 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4155 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4156 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004157 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004158 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4159 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4160 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004161
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004162 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4163 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4164 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004165 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4166 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4167 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4168 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004169 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4170 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4171 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004172
4173 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4174 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4175 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4176 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4177 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4178 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4179 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4180 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4181 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4182
4183 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4184 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4185 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4186 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4187 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4188 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4189 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4190 persistence cookie in the cache.
4191 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4192
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004193 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4194 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4195 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4196 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4197 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004198 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004199 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4200 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4201 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4202 they logout.
4203
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004204 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4205 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4206 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4207 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4208
4209 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4210 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4211 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4212 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4213 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4214 this attribute.
4215
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004216 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004217 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004218 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4219 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4220 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4221 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4222 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4223 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004224
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004225 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4226 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4227 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4228 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4229 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4230 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4231 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4232 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004233 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004234 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4235 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4236 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4237 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4238 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4239 the site.
4240
4241 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4242 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4243 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4244 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4245 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4246 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4247 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4248 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4249 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4250 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4251 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4252 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4253 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004254 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004255 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4256 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4257
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004258 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4259 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4260 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4261 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4262 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4263 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4264
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004265 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4266 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4267 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4268 repeated.
4269
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004270 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4271 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4272 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4273 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004274
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004275 Examples :
4276 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4277 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4278 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004279 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004280
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004281 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004282
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004283
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004284declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4285 Declares a capture slot.
4286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4287 no | yes | yes | no
4288 Arguments:
4289 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4290
4291 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4292 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4293 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4294 for use in the response.
4295
4296 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004297 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004298 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4299
4300
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004301default-server [param*]
4302 Change default options for a server in a backend
4303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4304 yes | no | yes | yes
4305 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004306 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4307 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4308 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4309 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004310
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004311 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004312 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4313
4314 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004315
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004316
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004317default_backend <backend>
4318 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4320 yes | yes | yes | no
4321 Arguments :
4322 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4323
4324 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4325 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4326 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4327 will catch all undetermined requests.
4328
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004329 Example :
4330
4331 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4332 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4333 default_backend dynamic
4334
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004335 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004336
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004337
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004338description <string>
4339 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4341 no | yes | yes | yes
4342 Arguments : string
4343
4344 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4345 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4346 it describes.
4347 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4348
4349
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004350disabled
4351 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4353 yes | yes | yes | yes
4354 Arguments : none
4355
4356 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4357 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4358 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4359 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4360 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4361 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4362 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4363
4364 See also : "enabled"
4365
4366
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004367dispatch <address>:<port>
4368 Set a default server address
4369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4370 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004371 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004372
4373 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4374 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4375 during start-up.
4376
4377 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4378 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4379 possible with normal servers.
4380
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004381 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004382 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4383 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4384 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4385 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4386
4387 See also : "server"
4388
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004389
4390dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4391 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4393 yes | no | yes | yes
4394 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4395
4396 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004397 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004398 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4399 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004400 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004401 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004402
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004403enabled
4404 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4406 yes | yes | yes | yes
4407 Arguments : none
4408
4409 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4410 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4411
4412 See also : "disabled"
4413
4414
4415errorfile <code> <file>
4416 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4418 yes | yes | yes | yes
4419 Arguments :
4420 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004421 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004422 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004423
4424 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004425 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004426 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004427 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4428 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004429
4430 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4431 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4432 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4433
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004434 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4435
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004436 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4437 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4438 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4439 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4440 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4441 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4442 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4443 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4444 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004445
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004446 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4447 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4448 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004449 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004450 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4451
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004452 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004453
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004454 Example :
4455 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004456 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004457 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4458 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4459
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004460
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004461errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4462 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4463 section.
4464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4465 yes | yes | yes | yes
4466 Arguments :
4467 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4468
4469 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004470 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004471 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004472
4473 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4474 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4475 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4476 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4477 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004478 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004479 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4480
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004481 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4482 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004483
4484 Example :
4485 errorfiles generic
4486 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4487
4488
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004489errorloc <code> <url>
4490errorloc302 <code> <url>
4491 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4493 yes | yes | yes | yes
4494 Arguments :
4495 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004496 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004497 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004498
4499 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4500 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4501 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4502 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004503 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004504
4505 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4506 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4507 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4508
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004509 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4510
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004511 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4512 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4513 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4514 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004515 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004516 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4517 request.
4518
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004519 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004520
4521
4522errorloc303 <code> <url>
4523 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4525 yes | yes | yes | yes
4526 Arguments :
4527 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004528 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004529 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004530
4531 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4532 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4533 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4534 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004535 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004536
4537 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4538 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4539 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4540
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004541 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4542
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004543 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4544 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4545 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4546 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004547 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004548
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004549 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004550
4551
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004552email-alert from <emailaddr>
4553 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004554 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004555 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4556 yes | yes | yes | yes
4557
4558 Arguments :
4559
4560 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4561
4562 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4563 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4564
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004565 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004566 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4567 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004568
4569
4570email-alert level <level>
4571 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4572 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4573 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4574 yes | yes | yes | yes
4575
4576 Arguments :
4577
4578 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4579 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4580 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4581
4582 By default level is alert
4583
4584 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4585 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4586 for the proxy.
4587
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004588 Alerts are sent when :
4589
4590 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4591 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4592 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4593 is notice or lower
4594 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4595 and a health check status update occurs
4596
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004597 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4598 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004599 section 3.6 about mailers.
4600
4601
4602email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4603 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4604 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4605 yes | yes | yes | yes
4606
4607 Arguments :
4608
4609 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4610
4611 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4612 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4613
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004614 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4615 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004616
4617
4618email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4619 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4620 mailers.
4621 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4622 yes | yes | yes | yes
4623
4624 Arguments :
4625
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004626 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004627
4628 By default the systems hostname is used.
4629
4630 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4631 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4632 for the proxy.
4633
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004634 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4635 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004636
4637
4638email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004639 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004640 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4641 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4642 yes | yes | yes | yes
4643
4644 Arguments :
4645
4646 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4647
4648 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4649 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4650
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004651 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004652 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4653
4654
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004655force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4656 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4657 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004658 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004659
4660 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4661 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4662 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4663 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4664 marked down for maintenance operations.
4665
4666 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4667 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4668 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4669 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4670 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4671 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4672 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4673 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4674 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4675
4676 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4677 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4678 is used.
4679
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004680 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004681 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004682
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004683
4684filter <name> [param*]
4685 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4687 no | yes | yes | yes
4688 Arguments :
4689 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4690 referenced in section 9.
4691
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004692 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004693 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004694 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4695 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004696
4697 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4698 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4699
4700 Example:
4701 listen
4702 bind *:80
4703
4704 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4705 filter compression
4706 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4707
4708 compression algo gzip
4709 compression offload
4710
4711 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4712
4713 See also : section 9.
4714
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004715
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004716fullconn <conns>
4717 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4719 yes | no | yes | yes
4720 Arguments :
4721 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4722 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4723
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004724 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004725 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004726 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004727 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4728 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4729 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4730 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4731 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004732 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004733
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004734 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4735 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004736 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4737 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4738 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004739
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004740 Example :
4741 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4742 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4743 # connections.
4744 backend dynamic
4745 fullconn 10000
4746 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4747 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4748
4749 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4750
4751
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004752grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004753 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004755 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004756 Arguments :
4757 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4758 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4759 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4760
4761 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4762 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004763 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004764 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4765
4766 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4767 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4768 simplify it.
4769
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004770
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004771hash-balance-factor <factor>
4772 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4774 yes | no | no | yes
4775 Arguments :
4776 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4777 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004778 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004779
4780 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4781 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4782 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4783 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4784 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4785 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4786 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4787
4788 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4789 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4790 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4791 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4792 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4793
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004794 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4795 consistent hashing mechanism.
4796
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004797 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4798
4799
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004800hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004801 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4803 yes | no | yes | yes
4804 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004805 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4806 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004807
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004808 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4809 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4810 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4811 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4812 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4813 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4814 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4815 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4816 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4817 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004818
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004819 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4820 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4821 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4822 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4823 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4824 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4825 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4826 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4827 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4828 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4829 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4830 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4831 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004832 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4833 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004834
4835 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4836
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004837 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004838 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4839 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4840 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004841 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4842 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4843 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004844
4845 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4846 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004847 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4848 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4849 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4850 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4851
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004852 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4853 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4854 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4855 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4856 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4857 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4858 parameter.
4859
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004860 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4861 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4862 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4863 used on strings.
4864
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004865 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4866
4867 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4868 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4869 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4870 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4871 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4872 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4873 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4874 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4875 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4876 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4877 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4878 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004879
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004880 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4881 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4882 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004883
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004884 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004885
4886
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004887http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4888 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4889 ones).
4890
4891 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4892 no | yes | yes | yes
4893
4894 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4895 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4896 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4897 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4898 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4899 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4900
4901 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4902 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4903 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4904
4905 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4906 below.
4907
4908 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4909 instance.
4910
4911 Example:
4912 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4913 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4914 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4915
4916http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4917
4918 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4919 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4920 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4921 example, or to pass some internal information.
4922 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4923 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4924 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4925
4926http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4927
4928 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4929 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4930
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004931http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004932
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004933 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
4934 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
4935 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
4936 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
4937 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004938
4939http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4940 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4941
4942 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4943
4944 Example:
4945 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4946
4947 # applied to:
4948 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4949
4950 # outputs:
4951 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4952
4953 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4954
4955http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4956 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4957
4958 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4959
4960 Example:
4961 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4962
4963 # applied to:
4964 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4965
4966 # outputs:
4967 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4968
4969http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4970
4971 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4972 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4973 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4974
4975http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4976 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4977
4978 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4979 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4980 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4981 fallback.
4982
4983 Example:
4984 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4985 http-response set-status 431
4986 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4987 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4988
4989http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4990
4991 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4992 inline.
4993
4994 Arguments:
4995 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4996 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4997 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4998 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4999 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5000 (request and response)
5001 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5002 processing
5003 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5004 processing
5005 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5006 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5007 and '_'.
5008
5009 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5010 followed by some converters.
5011
5012 Example:
5013 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5014
5015http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5016
5017 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5018 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5019 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5020 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5021 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005022 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005023 processing.
5024
5025 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5026 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005027 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005028 rules evaluation.
5029
5030http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5031
5032 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5033 details about <var-name>.
5034
5035 Example:
5036 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5037
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005038
5039http-check comment <string>
5040 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5041 it fails.
5042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5043 yes | no | yes | yes
5044
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005045 Arguments :
5046 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5047 rule fails.
5048
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005049 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5050 user-friendly error reporting.
5051
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005052 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005053 "http-check expect".
5054
5055
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005056http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5057 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005058 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005059 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5061 yes | no | yes | yes
5062
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005063 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005064 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5065
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005066 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005067 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005068
5069 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5070 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5071 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5072 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5073
5074 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5075
5076 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5077
5078 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5079
5080 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5081
5082 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5083
5084 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5085 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5086 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5087 is used.
5088
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005089 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5090 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5091 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5092 haproxy -vv.
5093
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005094 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5095
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005096 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5097 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5098 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5099 different ports or with different servers.
5100
5101 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5102 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5103 the port with a "http-check connect".
5104
5105 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5106 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5107 do.
5108
5109 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5110 unset-var or comment rules.
5111
5112 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005113 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5114 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5115 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5116 option httpchk
5117
5118 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005119 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005120 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005121 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005122 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005123 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005124
5125 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5126
5127 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005128
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005129
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005130http-check disable-on-404
5131 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005133 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005134 Arguments : none
5135
5136 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5137 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5138 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5139 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5140 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5141 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5142 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5143 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005144 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5145 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
5146 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
5147
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005148 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005149
5150
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005151http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005152 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5153 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5154 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005155 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005157 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005158
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005159 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005160 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5161
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005162 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5163 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5164 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5165 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5166 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5167 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5168 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5169 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5170 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5171 result is always conclusive.
5172
5173 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5174 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5175 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005176 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5177 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
5178 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
5179 example 404 with disable-on-404
5180 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5181 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5182 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005183
5184 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5185 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005186 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
5187 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5188 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5189 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5190 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5191 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005192
5193 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5194 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005195 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5196 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5197 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5198 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005199 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5200
5201 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5202 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5203 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5204 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5205
5206 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5207 informational message reported in logs if an error
5208 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5209 log-format string.
5210
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005211 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005212 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5213 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005214 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5215 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5216 details on the supported keywords.
5217
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005218 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5219 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5220 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5221 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005222
5223 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5224 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5225 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5226 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5227 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5228
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005229 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5230 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5231 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5232 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5233 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5234 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5235 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005236
5237 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005238 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005239 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5240 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5241 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5242 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5243
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005244 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5245 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005246 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5247 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5248 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5249 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5250 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5251 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5252 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5253 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005254 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5255 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5256 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5257 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5258 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5259 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5260 insensitive on the header names.
5261
5262 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5263 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5264 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5265 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5266 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5267 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005268
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005269 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005270 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005271 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5272 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5273 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5274 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5275 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005276 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005277 trace).
5278
5279 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005280 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005281 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5282 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5283 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5284 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5285 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005286 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005287
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005288 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5289 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5290 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5291 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5292 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5293 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5294
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005295 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
5296 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
5297 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5298 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5299 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5300 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5301 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5302 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5303
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005304 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5305 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5306 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5307 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5308 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005309
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005310 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5311 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5312
5313 Examples :
5314 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005315 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005316
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005317 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5318 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5319
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005320 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005321 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005322
5323 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005324 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005325
5326 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005327 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005328
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005329 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005330 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005331
5332
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005333http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005334 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5335 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005336 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5337 health checks.
5338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5339 yes | no | yes | yes
5340 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005341 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5342
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005343 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5344 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5345 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5346 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5347 to invent non-standard ones.
5348
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005349 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5350 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5351 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5352 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5353
5354 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5355 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5356 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5357 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005358
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005359 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005360 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005361 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005362 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5363 to add it.
5364
5365 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5366 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5367 to the log-format rules.
5368
5369 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5370 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5371 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005372
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005373 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5374 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5375 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5376 request.
5377
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005378 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5379 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5380 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005381 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5382 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5383 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5384 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005385 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005386 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005387 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
5388
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005389 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
5390 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005391 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
5392 so, it will be ignored.
5393
5394 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5395 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5396 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5397 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5398 configured request authority.
5399
5400 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5401 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005402
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005403 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005404
5405
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005406http-check send-state
5407 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5409 yes | no | yes | yes
5410 Arguments : none
5411
5412 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5413 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5414 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5415 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5416 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5417
5418 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5419 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5420 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5421 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5422 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005423 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5424 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5425 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5426
5427 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5428 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5429 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5430
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005431 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5432 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5433 checked in multiple backends.
5434
5435 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5436 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5437
5438 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5439 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5440 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5441 one fails.
5442
5443 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5444 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5445 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5446
5447 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5448 server's queue.
5449
5450 Example of a header received by the application server :
5451 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5452 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5453
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005454 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5455 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005456
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005457
5458http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005459 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005460 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5461 yes | no | yes | yes
5462
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005463 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005464 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5465 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5466 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5467 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5468 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5469 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5470 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5471 and '-'.
5472
5473 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5474
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005475 Examples :
5476 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005477
5478
5479http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005480 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005481 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5482 yes | no | yes | yes
5483
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005484 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005485 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5486 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5487 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5488 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5489 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5490 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5491 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5492 and '-'.
5493
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005494 Examples :
5495 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005496
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005497
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005498http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5499 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5500 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5501 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5502 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5504 yes | yes | yes | yes
5505 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005506 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005507 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005508 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5509 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005510
5511 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5512 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5513 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5514 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5515
5516 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5517 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5518 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5519 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5520
5521 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5522 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5523 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5524 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5525 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5526 chroot is performed.
5527
5528 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5529 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5530 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5531 considered.
5532
5533 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5534 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5535 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5536 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5537 considered as a raw string.
5538
5539 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5540 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5541 "content-type".
5542
5543 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5544 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5545 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5546 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5547 evaluated as a log-format string.
5548
5549 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5550 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5551 argument to "content-type".
5552
5553 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5554 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5555 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5556 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5557
5558 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5559 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5560 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5561 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5562 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5563 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5564 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5565 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5566
5567 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5568 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5569 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5570
5571 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5572 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5573
5574
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005575http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005576 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5577
5578 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5579 no | yes | yes | yes
5580
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005581 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5582 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5583 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5584 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5585 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005587 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5588 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005589
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005590 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005592 Example:
5593 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5594 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5595 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005596
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005597 http-request allow if nagios
5598 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5599 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5600 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005602 Example:
5603 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5604 acl add path /addacl
5605 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005606
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005607 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005608
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005609 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5610 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005612 Example:
5613 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5614 acl setmap path /setmap
5615 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005617 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005619 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5620 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005621
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005622 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5623 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005625http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005627 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5628 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5629 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5630 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5631 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5632 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5633 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5634 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005635
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005636http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005638 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5639 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5640 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5641 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5642 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5643 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5644 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5645 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005647http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005649 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5650 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005651
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005652
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005653http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005655 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5656 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5657 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5658 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5659 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005660
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005661 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5662 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5663 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5664 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5665 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5666 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5667 instead.
5668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005669 Example:
5670 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5671 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005672
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005673http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005674
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005675 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005676
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005677http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5678 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005679
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005680 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5681 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5682 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5683 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5684 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5685 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5686 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5687 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5688 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005689
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005690 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5691 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5692 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005693 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5694
5695 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5696 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5697 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5698 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005700http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005701
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005702 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5703 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5704 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5705 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5706 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5707 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005708
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005709http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005710
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005711 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5712 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5713 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5714 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5715 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005716
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005717http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005718
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005719 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5720 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5721 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5722 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5723 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5724 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005725
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005726http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5727http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5728 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5729 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5730 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5731 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005732
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005733 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5734 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5735 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005736 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005737 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5738 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5739 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005740 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005741 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005742
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005743http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5744 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5745 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5746 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5747
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005748http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5749
5750 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5751 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5752 pointed by <resolvers>.
5753 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5754 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5755 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5756 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5757 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5758 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5759 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5760 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5761 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5762 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5763 to 0.0.0.0.
5764
5765 Example:
5766 resolvers mydns
5767 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5768 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5769 timeout retry 1s
5770 hold valid 10s
5771 hold nx 3s
5772 hold other 3s
5773 hold obsolete 0s
5774 accepted_payload_size 8192
5775
5776 frontend fe
5777 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5778 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5779 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5780
5781 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5782 # which mean DNS resolution error
5783 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5784
5785 default_backend be
5786
5787 backend b_503
5788 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5789 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5790 # 503 error page to end users
5791
5792 backend be
5793 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5794 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5795 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5796 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5797 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5798
5799 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5800 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5801
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005802http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5803
5804 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5805 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5806 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5807 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005808 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5809 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005810
5811 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5812
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005813http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005814
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005815 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5816 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5817 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5818 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5819 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005820
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005821http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005822
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005823 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5824 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5825 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5826 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005827
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005828http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5829 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005830
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005831 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005832 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5833 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5834 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5835 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5836 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005837
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005838 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5839 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5840 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5841 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5842 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005843
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005844 Example:
5845 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5846
5847 # applied to:
5848 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5849
5850 # outputs:
5851 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5852
5853 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005854
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005855 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5856
5857 # applied to:
5858 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005859
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005860 # outputs:
5861 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005862
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005863http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5864 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5865
5866 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5867 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005868 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5869 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5870 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005871
5872 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5873 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5874 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5875
5876 Example:
5877 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5878 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5879
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005880 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5881 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5882 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5883 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5884
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005885http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5886 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5887
5888 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5889 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5890 query-string are replaced.
5891
5892 Example:
5893 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5894 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5895
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005896http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5897 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5898
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005899 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5900 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5901 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5902 against.
5903
5904 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5905 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5906 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005907
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005908 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5909 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5910 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5911 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5912 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5913 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5914 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5915 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5916 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005917 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5918 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005919
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005920 Example:
5921 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5922 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005923
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005924 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5925 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005926
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005927http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5928 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005929
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005930 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5931 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5932 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5933 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005934
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005935 Example:
5936 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005937
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005938 # applied to:
5939 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005940
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005941 # outputs:
5942 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005943
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005944http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5945 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5946 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005947 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005948 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5949
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005950 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005951 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5952 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005953 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005954 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005955 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005956 are followed to create the response :
5957
5958 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5959 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5960 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5961 ignored.
5962
5963 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5964 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005965 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005966 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5967 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005968
5969 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5970 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5971 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005972 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005973 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005974
5975 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5976 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5977 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005978 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005979 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5980 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005981
5982 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5983 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5984 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5985 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5986 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5987 as a raw content.
5988
5989 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5990 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5991 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5992 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5993 considered as a raw string.
5994
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005995 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005996 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5997 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5998 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5999
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006000 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6001 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006002 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006003
6004 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6005
6006 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006007 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006008 if { path /ping }
6009
6010 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6011 if { path /favicon.ico }
6012
6013 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6014 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6015 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6016
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006017http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6018http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006019
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006020 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6021 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6022 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006023
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006024http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6025 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006026
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006027 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6028 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6029 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6030 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006031
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006032http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006034 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6035 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6036 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6037 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6038 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006039
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006040 Arguments:
6041 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6042 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006043
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006044 Example:
6045 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6046 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006047
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006048 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6049 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006050
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006051http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006052
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006053 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6054 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6055 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006056
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006057 Arguments:
6058 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6059 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006060
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006061 Example:
6062 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6063 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006064
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006065 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6066 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6067 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006068
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006069http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006070
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006071 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6072 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6073 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6074 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6075 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006076
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006077 Example:
6078 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6079 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6080 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6081 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6082 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6083 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6084 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6085 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6086 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006087
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006088http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006089
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006090 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6091 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6092 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6093 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6094 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006095
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006096http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6097 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006098
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006099 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6100 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6101 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6102 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6103 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6104 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6105 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6106 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6107 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006108
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006109http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006110
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006111 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6112 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6113 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6114 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6115 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6116 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6117 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006118
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006119http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006120
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006121 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6122 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6123 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006124
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006125http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006126
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006127 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6128 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6129 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6130 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6131 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6132 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6133 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6134 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006135
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006136http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006137
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006138 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6139 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6140 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6141 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6142 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6143 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006144
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006145 Example :
6146 # prepend the host name before the path
6147 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006148
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006149http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6150
6151 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6152 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6153 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6154
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006155http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006156
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006157 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6158 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6159 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6160 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6161 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006162
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006163http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006164
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006165 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6166 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6167 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6168 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6169 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6170 values have higher priority.
6171 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6172 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6173 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6174 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6175 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006176
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006177http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006179 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6180 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6181 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6182 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6183 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6184 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6185 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006186
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006187 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006188
6189 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006190 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6191 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006192
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006193http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6194 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6195 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6196 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006197 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6198 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006199
6200 Arguments :
6201 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6202 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006203
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006204 See also "option forwardfor".
6205
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006206 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006207 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6208 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6209
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006210 # After the masking this will track connections
6211 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6212 http-request track-sc0 src
6213
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006214 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6215 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6216
6217http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6218
6219 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6220 expression.
6221
6222 Arguments:
6223 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6224 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006225
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006226 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006227 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6228 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6229
6230 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6231 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6232 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6233
6234http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6235
6236 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6237 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6238 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6239 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6240 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6241 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6242 information from the request.
6243
6244 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6245
6246http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6247
6248 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6249 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6250 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6251 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6252 path and the query string.
6253 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6254
6255http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6256
6257 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6258 inline.
6259
6260 Arguments:
6261 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6262 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6263 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6264 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6265 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6266 (request and response)
6267 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6268 processing
6269 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6270 processing
6271 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6272 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6273 and '_'.
6274
6275 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6276 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006277
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006278 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006279 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006280
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006281http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6282 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006284 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6285 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6286 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6287 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6288 agent name must be used.
6289
6290 Arguments:
6291 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6292
6293 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6294 configuration.
6295
6296http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6297
6298 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6299 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6300 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6301 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6302 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6303 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6304 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6305 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6306 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6307 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6308 action.
6309 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6310 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6311 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6312 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6313 you fully understand how it works.
6314
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006315http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6316
6317 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6318 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6319 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6320 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6321 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006322 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006323 processing.
6324
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006325 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006326 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6327 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6328 rules evaluation.
6329
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006330http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6331http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6332 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6333 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6334 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6335 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006336
6337 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6338 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6339 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006340 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6341 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6342 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6343 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6344 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6345 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6346 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6347 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6348 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6349 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006350 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006351 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6352 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6353 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6354 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6355 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006356
6357http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6358http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6359http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6360
6361 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6362 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6363 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6364 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006365 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006366 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6367 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6368 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6369 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6370 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6371 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6372 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6373
6374 Arguments :
6375 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6376 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6377 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6378 select which table entry to update the counters.
6379
6380 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6381 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6382 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6383 that table until the session ends.
6384
6385 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6386 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6387 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6388 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6389 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6390 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6391 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6392 useful information.
6393
6394 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6395 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6396 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6397 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6398 checks that make use of it.
6399
6400http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6401
6402 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006403
6404 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006405 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006406
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006407http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6408
6409 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6410 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6411 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6412 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6413 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6414 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6415
6416 Arguments :
6417 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6418
6419 Example:
6420 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6421
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006422http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006423
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006424 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6425 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6426 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006427
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006428
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006429http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006430 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6431
6432 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6433 no | yes | yes | yes
6434
6435 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6436 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6437 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6438 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6439 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6440 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6441
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006442 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6443 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006444
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006445 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006446
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006447 Example:
6448 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006449
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006450 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006451
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006452 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6453 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006454
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006455 Example:
6456 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006457
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006458 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006459
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006460 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6461 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006462
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006463 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6464 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006465
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006466http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006467
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006468 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6469 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6470 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6471 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6472 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6473 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6474 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6475 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006476
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006477http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006478
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006479 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6480 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6481 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6482 example, or to pass some internal information.
6483 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6484 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6485 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006486
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006487http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006488
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006489 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6490 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006491
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006492http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006493
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006494 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006495
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006496http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006497
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006498 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6499 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6500 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6501 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6502 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6503 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6504 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006505
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006506 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6507 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6508 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6509 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6510 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006511
6512 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6513 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6514 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6515 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006516
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006517http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006518
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006519 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6520 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6521 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6522 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6523 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6524 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006525
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006526http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006527
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006528 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6529 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6530 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6531 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6532 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006533
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006534http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006535
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006536 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6537 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6538 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6539 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6540 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6541 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006542
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006543http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6544http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6545 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6546 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6547 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6548 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006549
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006550 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6551 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6552 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006553 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006554 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6555 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6556 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006557 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006558 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006559
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006560http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006561
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006562 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6563 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6564 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6565 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6566 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6567 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006568
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006569http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6570 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006571
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006572 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6573 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006574
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006575 Example:
6576 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006577
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006578 # applied to:
6579 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006580
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006581 # outputs:
6582 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006583
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006584 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006585
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006586http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6587 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006588
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006589 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006590 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006591
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006592 Example:
6593 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006594
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006595 # applied to:
6596 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006597
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006598 # outputs:
6599 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006600
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006601http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6602 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6603 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006604 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006605 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6606
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006607 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006608 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6609 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006610 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006611 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006612 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006613 are followed to create the response :
6614
6615 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6616 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6617 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6618 ignored.
6619
6620 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6621 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006622 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006623 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6624 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006625
6626 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6627 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6628 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006629 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006630 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006631
6632 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6633 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6634 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006635 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006636 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6637 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006638
6639 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6640 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6641 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6642 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6643 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6644 as a raw content.
6645
6646 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6647 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6648 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6649 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6650 considered as a raw string.
6651
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006652 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6653 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6654 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6655 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6656
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006657 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6658 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006659 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006660
6661 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6662
6663 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006664 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006665 if { status eq 404 }
6666
6667 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6668 string "This is the end !" \
6669 if { status eq 500 }
6670
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006671http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6672http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006673
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006674 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6675 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6676 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006677
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006678http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6679 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006680
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006681 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6682 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6683 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6684 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006685
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006686http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006687
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006688 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6689 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6690 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6691 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6692 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006693
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006694 Arguments:
6695 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006696
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006697 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6698 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006699
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006700http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006701
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006702 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6703 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6704 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006705
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006706http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6707
6708 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6709 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6710 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6711 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6712 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6713
6714http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6715
6716 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6717 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6718 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6719 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6720 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6721 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6722 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6723 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6724 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6725
6726http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6727
6728 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6729 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6730 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6731 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6732 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6733 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6734 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6735
6736http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6737
6738 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6739 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6740 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6741 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6742 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6743 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6744 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6745 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6746
6747http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6748 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6749
6750 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6751 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6752 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6753 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006754
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006755 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006756 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6757 http-response set-status 431
6758 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6759 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006760
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006761http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006762
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006763 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6764 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6765 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6766 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6767 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6768 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6769 based on some information from the request.
6770
6771 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6772
6773http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6774
6775 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6776 inline.
6777
6778 Arguments:
6779 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6780 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6781 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6782 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6783 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6784 (request and response)
6785 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6786 processing
6787 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6788 processing
6789 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6790 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6791 and '_'.
6792
6793 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6794 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006795
6796 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006797 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006798
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006799http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006800
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006801 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6802 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6803 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6804 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6805 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6806 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6807 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6808 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6809 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6810 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6811 action.
6812 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6813 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6814 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6815 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6816 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006817
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006818http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6819
6820 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6821 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6822 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6823 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6824 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006825 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006826 processing.
6827
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006828 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006829 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006830 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006831 rules evaluation.
6832
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006833http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6834http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6835http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006836
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006837 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6838 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6839 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6840 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6841 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6842 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6843
6844http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6845
6846 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6847 about <var-name>.
6848
6849 Example:
6850 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6851
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006852
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006853http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6854 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6855
6856 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6857 yes | no | yes | yes
6858
6859 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006860 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6861 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6862 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006863
6864 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6865
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006866 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6867 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6868 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6869 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6870 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6871 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6872 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6873 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6874 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6875 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006876
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006877 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6878 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6879 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6880 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6881 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6882 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6883 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02006884 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
6885 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
6886 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
6887 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
6888 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
6889 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006890
6891 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6892 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6893 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6894 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6895 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6896 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6897 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6898 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006899 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006900 downsides of rare connection failures.
6901
6902 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6903 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6904 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6905 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6906 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6907 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006908 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006909 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6910 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6911 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6912 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6913 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6914
6915 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006916 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6917 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6918 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006919
Amaury Denoyelle7239c242020-10-15 16:41:09 +02006920 - connections sent to a server with a variable value as TLS SNI extension
6921 are marked private and are never shared. This is not the case if the SNI
6922 is guaranteed to be a constant, as for example using a literal string;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006923
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006924 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6925 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006926
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006927 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006928
6929 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6930 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6931 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6932
6933 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6934
6935
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006936http-send-name-header [<header>]
6937 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006938 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6939 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006940 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006941 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6942
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006943 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6944 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6945 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6946 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6947 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6948 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6949 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6950 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6951 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6952 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6953 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6954 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6955 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6956 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6957 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6958 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006959
6960 See also : "server"
6961
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006962id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006963 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6965 no | yes | yes | yes
6966 Arguments : none
6967
6968 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6969 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6970 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006971
6972
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006973ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6974 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6975 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006976 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006977
6978 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6979 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6980 and running).
6981
6982 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6983 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6984 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006985 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006986 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6987
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006988 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6989 "unless" condition is met.
6990
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006991 Example:
6992 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6993 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6994 ignore-persist if url_static
6995
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006996 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6997
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006998load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6999 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7000 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7001 yes | no | yes | yes
7002
7003 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7004 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7005 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007006 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007007 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7008 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7009 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7010 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7011
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007012 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007013 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007014 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007015
7016 Arguments:
7017 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7018 named "server-state-file".
7019
7020 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7021 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7022 name is used as a file name.
7023
7024 none don't load any stat for this backend
7025
7026 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007027 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7028 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7029 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007030 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007031 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007032
7033 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7034 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7035
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007036 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007037
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007038 global
7039 stats socket /tmp/socket
7040 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007041
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007042 defaults
7043 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007044
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007045 backend bk
7046 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7047 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007048
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007049
7050 Then one can run :
7051
7052 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7053
7054 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7055
7056 1
7057 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7058 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7059 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7060
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007061 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007062
7063 global
7064 stats socket /tmp/socket
7065 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7066
7067 defaults
7068 load-server-state-from-file local
7069
7070 backend bk
7071 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7072 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7073
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007074
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007075 Then one can run :
7076
7077 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7078
7079 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7080
7081 1
7082 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7083 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7084 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7085
7086 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7087 "show servers state"
7088
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007089
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007090log global
Jan Wagnerf2f5c4e2020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007091log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007092 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007093no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007094 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7096 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007097
7098 Prefix :
7099 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7100 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7101 prefix does not allow arguments.
7102
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007103 Arguments :
7104 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7105 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7106 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7107 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7108 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7109 parameter.
7110
7111 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7112 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7113
7114 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7115 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7116 standard syslog port).
7117
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007118 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7119 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7120 standard syslog port).
7121
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007122 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7123 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7124 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007125 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007126
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007127 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7128 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7129 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7130 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7131 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7132 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7133 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7134 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7135 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7136 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7137 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7138 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7139 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7140 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7141 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7142 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007143 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7144 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007145
7146 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7147 and "fd@2", see above.
7148
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007149 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7150 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7151 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7152 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7153 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7154 having the logs instantly available.
7155
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007156 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7157 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007158
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007159 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7160 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7161 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7162 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7163 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7164 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7165 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7166 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7167 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7168 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007169 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007170
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007171 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7172 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7173 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7174 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7175 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7176
7177 <sample_size>
7178 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7179 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7180 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7181 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7182 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7183
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007184 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7185 one of the following :
7186
Emeric Bruna0338b92020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007187 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7188 field is stripped. This is the default.
7189 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7190 rfc3164.
7191
7192 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007193 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7194
7195 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7196 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7197
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007198 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7199 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7200 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7201 designed to be used with a local log server.
7202
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007203 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7204 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7205 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7206 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7207 systemd logger consumes.
7208
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007209 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7210 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7211 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7212 used with a local log server.
7213
7214 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7215 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7216 designed to be used with a local log server.
7217
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007218 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7219 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7220 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7221 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7222
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007223 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7224
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007225 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7226 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7227 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7228
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007229 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7230 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7231 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7232 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007233
7234 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7235 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7236 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007237 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7238 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7239 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7240 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7241 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007242
7243 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7244
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007245 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7246 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7247 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007248
7249 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7250 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7251 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7252 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7253
7254 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7255 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007256
7257 Example :
7258 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007259 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7260 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7261 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007262 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
7263 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007264 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007265
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007266
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007267log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007268 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7269 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7270 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007271
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007272 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7273 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7274 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7275 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7276 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007277
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007278 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7279 "option httplog" directives.
7280
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007281log-format-sd <string>
7282 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7283 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7284 yes | yes | yes | no
7285
7286 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7287 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7288 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7289 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7290 which covers the log format string in depth.
7291
7292 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7293 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7294
7295 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7296 log format to "rfc5424".
7297
7298 Example :
7299 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7300
7301
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007302log-tag <string>
7303 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7304 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7305 yes | yes | yes | yes
7306
7307 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7308 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7309 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7310 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7311 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7312 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7313 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7314 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7315 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007316
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007317max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7318 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7319 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7320 yes | no | yes | yes
7321
7322 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7323 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7324 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7325 servers.
7326
7327 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7328 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7329 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7330 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7331 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007332 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007333 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7334 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7335 picking a different server.
7336
7337 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7338 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7339 even if they have to be queued.
7340
7341 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7342 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7343
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007344max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7345 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7346 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7347 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007348
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007349maxconn <conns>
7350 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7352 yes | yes | yes | no
7353 Arguments :
7354 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7355 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7356 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7357 closes.
7358
7359 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7360 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7361 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7362 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007363 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7364 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7365 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7366 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007367
7368 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7369 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7370 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7371
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007372 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7373 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007374
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007375 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7376
7377
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007378mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007379 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7381 yes | yes | yes | yes
7382 Arguments :
7383 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7384 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7385 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7386 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7387
7388 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7389 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7390 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7391 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7392 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7393
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007394 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7395 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7396 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007397
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007398 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007399 defaults http_instances
7400 mode http
7401
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007402
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007403monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007404 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7406 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007407 Arguments :
7408 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7409 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007410 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007411 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7412 backend and its backup.
7413
7414 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7415 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7416 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7417 servers in a list of backends.
7418
7419 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7420 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7421 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7422 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7423 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7424 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7425 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007426 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7427 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007428
7429 Example:
7430 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007431 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007432 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7433 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7434 monitor-uri /site_alive
7435 monitor fail if site_dead
7436
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007437 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007438
7439
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007440monitor-uri <uri>
7441 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7443 yes | yes | yes | no
7444 Arguments :
7445 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7446 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7447
7448 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7449 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7450 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7451 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7452 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7453 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7454 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7455 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7456
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007457 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007458 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7459 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7460 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7461 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7462 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7463 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007464
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007465 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7466 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7467 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7468 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7469
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007470 Example :
7471 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7472 frontend www
7473 mode http
7474 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7475
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007476 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007477
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007478
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007479option abortonclose
7480no option abortonclose
7481 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7483 yes | no | yes | yes
7484 Arguments : none
7485
7486 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7487 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7488 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7489 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007490 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007491 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7492 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7493 encountered while delivering the response.
7494
7495 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7496 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7497 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7498 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7499 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7500 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007501 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007502 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007503 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007504 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7505 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7506 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7507
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007508 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7509 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007510 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7511 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7512 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7513 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7514 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7515 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007516 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007517
7518 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7519 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7520
7521 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7522
7523
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007524option accept-invalid-http-request
7525no option accept-invalid-http-request
7526 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7528 yes | yes | yes | no
7529 Arguments : none
7530
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007531 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007532 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007533 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007534 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7535 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7536 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7537 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7538 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007539 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7540 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7541 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7542 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007543 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007544 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007545 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7546 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7547 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007548
7549 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7550 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7551 been confirmed.
7552
7553 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7554 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007555 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7556 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007557 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7558
7559 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7560 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7561
7562 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7563 stats socket.
7564
7565
7566option accept-invalid-http-response
7567no option accept-invalid-http-response
7568 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7570 yes | no | yes | yes
7571 Arguments : none
7572
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007573 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007574 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007575 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007576 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7577 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7578 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7579 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7580 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007581 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7582 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7583 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007584
7585 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7586 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7587 been confirmed.
7588
7589 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7590 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7591 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7592 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7593
7594 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7595 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7596
7597 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7598 stats socket.
7599
7600
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007601option allbackups
7602no option allbackups
7603 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7605 yes | no | yes | yes
7606 Arguments : none
7607
7608 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7609 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7610 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7611 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7612 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7613 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7614 order between the backup servers anymore.
7615
7616 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7617 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7618
7619 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7620 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7621
7622
7623option checkcache
7624no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007625 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7627 yes | no | yes | yes
7628 Arguments : none
7629
7630 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7631 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007632 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007633 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7634 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007635 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007636
7637 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007638 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007639 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007640 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7641 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007642 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007643 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007644 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7645 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007646 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007647 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7648 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007649 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007650 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7651 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7652 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7653 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7654 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7655 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7656 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7657 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7658 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7659
7660 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007661 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7662 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7663 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7664 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007665
7666 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7667 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007668 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007669 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007670
7671 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7672 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7673
7674
7675option clitcpka
7676no option clitcpka
7677 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7679 yes | yes | yes | no
7680 Arguments : none
7681
7682 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7683 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007684 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007685 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7686
7687 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7688 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7689 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7690 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7691
7692 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7693 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7694 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7695 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7696 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7697
7698 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7699
7700 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7701 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7702 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7703
7704 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7705 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7706
7707 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7708
7709
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007710option contstats
7711 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7713 yes | yes | yes | no
7714 Arguments : none
7715
7716 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7717 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7718 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7719 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007720 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7721 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7722 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7723 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7724 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007725
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007726option disable-h2-upgrade
7727no option disable-h2-upgrade
7728 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7729 connection.
7730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7731 yes | yes | yes | no
7732 Arguments : none
7733
7734 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7735 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7736 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7737 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7738 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7739 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7740 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7741 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7742
7743 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7744 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007745
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007746option dontlog-normal
7747no option dontlog-normal
7748 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7750 yes | yes | yes | no
7751 Arguments : none
7752
7753 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7754 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7755 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7756 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7757 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7758 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7759 logged.
7760
7761 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7762 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7763 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007765 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007766 logging.
7767
7768
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007769option dontlognull
7770no option dontlognull
7771 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7773 yes | yes | yes | no
7774 Arguments : none
7775
7776 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7777 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7778 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7779 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7780 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7781 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007782 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7783 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7784 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007785
7786 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007787 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007788 would not be logged.
7789
7790 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7791 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7792
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007793 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007794 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007795
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007796
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007797option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007798 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7800 yes | yes | yes | yes
7801 Arguments :
7802 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7803 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007804 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007805 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007806
7807 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7808 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7809 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7810 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7811 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7812 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7813 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007814 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7815 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7816 possible that the client has already brought one.
7817
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007818 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007819 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007820 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007821 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007822 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007823 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007824
7825 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7826 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7827 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7828 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7829 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7830 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7831 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7832
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007833 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7834 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7835 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7836 are under the control of the end-user.
7837
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007838 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007839 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7840 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007841 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7842 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7843 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007844
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007845 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007846 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7847 frontend www
7848 mode http
7849 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7850
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007851 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7852 backend www
7853 mode http
7854 option forwardfor header X-Client
7855
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007856 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007857 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007858
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007859
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007860option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7861no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7862 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7864 yes | yes | yes | no
7865 Arguments : none
7866
7867 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7868 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7869 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7870 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7871 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7872 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7873 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7874
7875 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7876 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7877 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7878 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7879 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7880 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7881 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7882 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7883 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7884 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7885
7886 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7887
7888 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7889 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7890
7891 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7892 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7893
7894
7895option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7896no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7897 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7899 yes | no | yes | yes
7900 Arguments : none
7901
7902 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7903 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7904 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7905 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7906 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7907 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7908 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7909
7910 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7911 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7912 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7913 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7914 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7915 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7916 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7917 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7918 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7919 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7920
7921 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7922
7923 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7924 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7925
7926 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7927 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7928
7929
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007930option http-buffer-request
7931no option http-buffer-request
7932 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7934 yes | yes | yes | yes
7935 Arguments : none
7936
7937 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7938 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7939 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7940 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7941 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7942 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007943 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7944 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7945 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7946 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007947
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007948 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007949
7950
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007951option http-ignore-probes
7952no option http-ignore-probes
7953 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7955 yes | yes | yes | no
7956 Arguments : none
7957
7958 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7959 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7960 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7961 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7962 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7963 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7964 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7965 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7966 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007967 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7968 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007969 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7970
7971 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7972 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7973 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7974 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7975 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7976 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7977 are often the only way to detect them.
7978
7979 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7980 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7981
7982 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7983
7984
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007985option http-keep-alive
7986no option http-keep-alive
7987 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7989 yes | yes | yes | yes
7990 Arguments : none
7991
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007992 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7993 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007994 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7995 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007996 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7997 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7998 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007999
8000 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8001 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008002 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8003 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8004 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8005 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8006 situations where this option may be useful :
8007
8008 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008009 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008010
8011 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8012 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8013
8014 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8015 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8016 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8017 request.
8018
8019 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8020 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008021 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8022 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8023 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008024
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008025 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8026 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8027 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8028 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8029 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8030 not set.
8031
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008032 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8033 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8034 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008035
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008036 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008037 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008038 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008039
8040
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008041option http-no-delay
8042no option http-no-delay
8043 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8045 yes | yes | yes | yes
8046 Arguments : none
8047
8048 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8049 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8050 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8051 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8052 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8053 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8054 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8055 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8056 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8057 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8058 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8059 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8060 affected.
8061
8062 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8063 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8064 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8065 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8066 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8067 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8068 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8069 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8070 latency environments.
8071
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008072 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8073
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008074
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008075option http-pretend-keepalive
8076no option http-pretend-keepalive
8077 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008079 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008080 Arguments : none
8081
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008082 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008083 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8084 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8085 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8086 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8087 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8088 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8089 consider the response complete.
8090
8091 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8092 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8093 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8094 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008095 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008096 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8097
8098 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8099 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8100 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8101 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8102 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8103 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8104 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8105
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008106 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8107 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8108 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8109 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8110 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8111 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008112
8113 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8114 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8115
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008116 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008117 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008118
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008119
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008120option http-server-close
8121no option http-server-close
8122 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8124 yes | yes | yes | yes
8125 Arguments : none
8126
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008127 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8128 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8129 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8130 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008131 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8132 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8133 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8134 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8135 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8136 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8137 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8138 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8139 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8140 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8141 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008142
8143 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8144 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8145 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8146 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008147 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8148 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008149
8150 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8151 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008152 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8153 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8154 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008155
8156 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8157 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8158
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008159 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8160 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008161
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008162option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008163no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008164 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8166 yes | yes | yes | no
8167 Arguments : none
8168
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008169 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008170 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8171 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8172 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8173 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8174 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8175 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8176
8177 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8178 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008179 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8180 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8181 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008182
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008183 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8184 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8185 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8186 front of an existing proxy.
8187
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008188 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8189
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008190 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008191
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008192option httpchk
8193option httpchk <uri>
8194option httpchk <method> <uri>
8195option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008196 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8198 yes | no | yes | yes
8199 Arguments :
8200 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8201 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8202 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8203 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8204 ones.
8205
8206 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8207 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8208 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8209
8210 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8211 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8212 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008213 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008214
8215 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8216 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8217 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8218 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8219 the lack of any response.
8220
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008221 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8222 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8223 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8224 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8225
8226 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8227 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8228 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008229
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008230 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8231 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008232 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008233 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008234 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008235
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008236 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8237 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8238 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8239 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8240
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008241 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008242 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8243 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8244 backend https_relay
8245 mode tcp
8246 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8247 http-check send hdr Host www
8248 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008249
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008250 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8251 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8252 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008253
8254
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008255option httpclose
8256no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008257 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8259 yes | yes | yes | yes
8260 Arguments : none
8261
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008262 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8263 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8264 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8265 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008266 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008267
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008268 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8269 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008270 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008271 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8272 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008273
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008274 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8275 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8276 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008277
8278 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8279 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008280 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8281 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8282 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008283
8284 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8285 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8286
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008287 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008288
8289
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008290option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008291 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008293 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008294 Arguments :
8295 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8296 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8297 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008298 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008299 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008300
8301 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8302 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8303 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8304 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8305 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8306 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8307 ports.
8308
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008309 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8310 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008311
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008312 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8313
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008314 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008315
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008316
8317option http_proxy
8318no option http_proxy
8319 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8321 yes | yes | yes | yes
8322 Arguments : none
8323
8324 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8325 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8326 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8327 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8328 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8329
8330 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8331 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008332 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8333 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008334
8335 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8336 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8337
8338 Example :
8339 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8340 backend direct_forward
8341 option httpclose
8342 option http_proxy
8343
8344 See also : "option httpclose"
8345
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008346
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008347option independent-streams
8348no option independent-streams
8349 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8351 yes | yes | yes | yes
8352 Arguments : none
8353
8354 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8355 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8356 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8357 receive data or not.
8358
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008359 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008360 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8361 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8362 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8363 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8364 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8365 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8366 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8367 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8368 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8369 socket buffers.
8370
8371 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8372 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8373 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8374 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8375 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8376
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008377 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008378
8379
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008380option ldap-check
8381 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8383 yes | no | yes | yes
8384 Arguments : none
8385
8386 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8387 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8388 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8389 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8390
8391 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8392 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8393
8394 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8395 configure it.
8396
8397 Example :
8398 option ldap-check
8399
8400 See also : "option httpchk"
8401
8402
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008403option external-check
8404 Use external processes for server health checks
8405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8406 yes | no | yes | yes
8407
8408 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8409 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8410 command".
8411
8412 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8413
8414 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8415
8416
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008417option log-health-checks
8418no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008419 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8421 yes | no | yes | yes
8422 Arguments : none
8423
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008424 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8425 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8426 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008427
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008428 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8429 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8430 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8431 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8432 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8433
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008434 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008435 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008436
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008437 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8438 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8439 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008440
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008441
8442option log-separate-errors
8443no option log-separate-errors
8444 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8446 yes | yes | yes | no
8447 Arguments : none
8448
8449 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8450 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8451 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8452 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8453 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8454 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8455 provides very important information.
8456
8457 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8458 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8459 error logs.
8460
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008461 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008462 logging.
8463
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008464
8465option logasap
8466no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008467 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8469 yes | yes | yes | no
8470 Arguments : none
8471
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008472 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8473 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8474 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8475 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8476
8477 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8478 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8479 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8480 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8481 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008482 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008483 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8484 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8485 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8486 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008487 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008488
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008489 Examples :
8490 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8491 mode http
8492 option httplog
8493 option logasap
8494 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8495
8496 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8497 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8498 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8499 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8500
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008501 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008502 logging.
8503
8504
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008505option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008506 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8508 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008509 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008510 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8511 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008512 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8513 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008514
8515 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8516 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008517 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008518 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8519 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8520 in the MySQL table, like this :
8521
8522 USE mysql;
8523 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8524 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8525
8526 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008527 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008528 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8529 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8530 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8531 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8532 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8533 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8534 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8535
8536 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8537 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008538
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008539 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008540
8541 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8542 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8543 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8544 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008545 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8546 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008547
8548 See also: "option httpchk"
8549
8550
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008551option nolinger
8552no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008553 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008554 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8555 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008556 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008557
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008558 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008559 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8560 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8561 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8562 connections.
8563
8564 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8565 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008566 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8567 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8568 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8569 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8570 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8571 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8572 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8573 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8574 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8575 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8576 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8577 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8578 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008579
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008580 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8581 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8582 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8583 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8584 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008585
8586 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8587 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008588 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
8589 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidently
8590 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008591
8592 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8593 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8594
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008595 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8596 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008597
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008598option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8599 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8601 yes | yes | yes | yes
8602 Arguments :
8603 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8604 matching <network>
8605 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8606 header name.
8607
8608 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8609 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8610 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8611 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8612 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8613 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8614 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8615 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8616 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8617 possible that the client has already brought one.
8618
8619 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8620 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8621 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8622 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8623 header and requires different one.
8624
8625 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8626 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8627 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8628 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8629 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8630 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8631 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8632
8633 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8634 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8635 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8636 both are defined.
8637
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008638 Examples :
8639 # Original Destination address
8640 frontend www
8641 mode http
8642 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8643
8644 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8645 backend www
8646 mode http
8647 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8648
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008649 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008650
8651
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008652option persist
8653no option persist
8654 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8655 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8656 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008657 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008658
8659 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8660 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8661 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8662 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8663 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8664 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8665 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8666 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8667 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8668 redirected to another valid server.
8669
8670 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8671 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8672
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008673 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008674
8675
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008676option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8677 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8679 yes | no | yes | yes
8680 Arguments :
8681 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8682 PostgreSQL server.
8683
8684 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8685 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8686 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8687 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8688
8689 See also: "option httpchk"
8690
8691
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008692option prefer-last-server
8693no option prefer-last-server
8694 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8695 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8696 yes | no | yes | yes
8697 Arguments : none
8698
8699 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8700 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8701 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8702 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8703 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8704 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8705 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8706 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8707 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008708 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8709 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008710 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8711 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8712 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008713 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8714 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8715 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008716
8717 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8718 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8719
8720 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8721
8722
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008723option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008724option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008725no option redispatch
8726 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8727 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8728 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008729 Arguments :
8730 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8731 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8732 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008733 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008734 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008735 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008736 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8737 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8738 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8739
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008740
8741 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8742 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8743 be able to access the service anymore.
8744
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008745 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8746 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008747
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008748 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8749 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8750 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8751 following order:
8752
8753 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8754
8755 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8756 list, or
8757
8758 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8759
8760 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8761 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8762
8763 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8764 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8765 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8766 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8767
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008768 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008769 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8770 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008772 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8773 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8774
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008775 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008776
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008777
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008778option redis-check
8779 Use redis health checks for server testing
8780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8781 yes | no | yes | yes
8782 Arguments : none
8783
8784 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8785 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8786 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8787 find the "+PONG" response message.
8788
8789 Example :
8790 option redis-check
8791
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008792 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008793
8794
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008795option smtpchk
8796option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8797 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8799 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008800 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008801 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008802 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008803 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8804
8805 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8806 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8807 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8808
8809 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8810 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8811 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8812 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8813 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8814 dead server.
8815
8816 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8817 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008818 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008819 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8820
8821 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8822 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8823 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8824 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008825 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008826
8827 Example :
8828 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8829
8830 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8831
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008832
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008833option socket-stats
8834no option socket-stats
8835
8836 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8838 yes | yes | yes | no
8839
8840 Arguments : none
8841
8842
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008843option splice-auto
8844no option splice-auto
8845 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8847 yes | yes | yes | yes
8848 Arguments : none
8849
8850 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8851 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008852 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008853 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008854 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008855 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8856 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8857 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8858 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8859
8860 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8861 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8862 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8863 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8864 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8865 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8866 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8867 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8868 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8869 keyword.
8870
8871 Example :
8872 option splice-auto
8873
8874 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8875 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8876
8877 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8878 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8879
8880
8881option splice-request
8882no option splice-request
8883 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8885 yes | yes | yes | yes
8886 Arguments : none
8887
8888 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008889 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008890 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8891 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8892 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8893 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8894
8895 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8896
8897 Example :
8898 option splice-request
8899
8900 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8901 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8902
8903 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8904 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8905
8906
8907option splice-response
8908no option splice-response
8909 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8911 yes | yes | yes | yes
8912 Arguments : none
8913
8914 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008915 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008916 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8917 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8918 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8919 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8920
8921 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8922
8923 Example :
8924 option splice-response
8925
8926 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8927 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8928
8929 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8930 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8931
8932
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008933option spop-check
8934 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8936 no | no | no | yes
8937 Arguments : none
8938
8939 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8940 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8941 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8942 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8943
8944 Example :
8945 option spop-check
8946
8947 See also : "option httpchk"
8948
8949
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008950option srvtcpka
8951no option srvtcpka
8952 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8954 yes | no | yes | yes
8955 Arguments : none
8956
8957 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8958 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008959 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008960 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8961
8962 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8963 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8964 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8965 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8966
8967 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8968 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8969 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8970 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8971 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8972
8973 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8974
8975 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8976 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8977 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8978
8979 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8980 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8981
8982 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8983
8984
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008985option ssl-hello-chk
8986 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8988 yes | no | yes | yes
8989 Arguments : none
8990
8991 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8992 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8993 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8994 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8995 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8996 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8997 hello message.
8998
8999 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9000 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9001 messages, which is appreciable.
9002
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009003 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9004 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9005 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009006
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009007 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9008
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009009
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009010option tcp-check
9011 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9012 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9013 yes | no | yes | yes
9014
9015 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9016 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9017
9018 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9019 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9020 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9021
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009022 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009023 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9024 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9025 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9026 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9027 only.
9028
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009029 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009030 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9031 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9032 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9033 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9034
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009035 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009036 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9037 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009038 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009039 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9040 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9041 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9042 the respective protocols.
9043 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009044 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009045
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009046 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009047
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009048 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9049 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9050 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9051 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009052
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009053 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9054 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9055 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009056
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009057
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009058 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009059 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009060 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009061 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009062
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009063 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009064 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009065 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009066
9067 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9068 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009069 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009070 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009071 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009072 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009073 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009074 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009075 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9076 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009077 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009078 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9079 tcp-check expect string +OK
9080
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009081 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009082 (send many headers before analyzing)
9083 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009084 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009085 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9086 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9087 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9088 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009089 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009090
9091
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009092 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009093
9094
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009095option tcp-smart-accept
9096no option tcp-smart-accept
9097 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9099 yes | yes | yes | no
9100 Arguments : none
9101
9102 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9103 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9104 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9105 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9106 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9107 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9108
9109 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9110 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9111 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9112 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9113
9114 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9115 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9116 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009117 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009118
9119 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9120 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9121 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9122
9123 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9124 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9125 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9126
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009127 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9128
9129
9130option tcp-smart-connect
9131no option tcp-smart-connect
9132 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9134 yes | no | yes | yes
9135 Arguments : none
9136
9137 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9138 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9139 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9140 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9141 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9142
9143 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9144 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9145 complex.
9146
9147 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9148 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9149 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9150
9151 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9152 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9153
9154 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9155
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009156
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009157option tcpka
9158 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9160 yes | yes | yes | yes
9161 Arguments : none
9162
9163 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9164 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009165 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009166 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9167
9168 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9169 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9170 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9171 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9172
9173 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9174 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9175 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9176 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9177 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9178
9179 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9180
9181 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9182 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9183 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9184 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9185 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9186 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9187 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9188 backends.
9189
9190 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9191
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009192
9193option tcplog
9194 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009196 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009197 Arguments : none
9198
9199 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9200 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9201 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9202 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9203 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9204 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9205 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9206 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9207
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009208 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009210 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009211
9212
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009213option transparent
9214no option transparent
9215 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009217 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009218 Arguments : none
9219
9220 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9221 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9222 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9223 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9224 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9225 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9226 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9227 appropriate server.
9228
9229 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9230 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9231
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009232 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009233 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009234
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009235
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009236external-check command <command>
9237 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9239 yes | no | yes | yes
9240
9241 Arguments :
9242 <command> is the external command to run
9243
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009244 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9245
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009246 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009247
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009248 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9249 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9250 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9251 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9252 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9253 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009254
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009255 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9256
9257 Environment variables :
9258 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9259 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9260
9261 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9262
9263 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9264
9265 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9266 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9267 for a UNIX socket).
9268
9269 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9270
9271 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9272
9273 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9274
9275 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9276
9277 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9278
9279 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9280 socket).
9281
9282 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9283 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9284
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009285 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9286
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009287 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9288 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9289 failed.
9290
9291 Example :
9292 external-check command /bin/true
9293
9294 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9295
9296
9297external-check path <path>
9298 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9300 yes | no | yes | yes
9301
9302 Arguments :
9303 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9304
9305 The default path is "".
9306
9307 Example :
9308 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9309
9310 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9311 "external-check command"
9312
9313
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009314persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009315persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009316 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9318 yes | no | yes | yes
9319 Arguments :
9320 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009321 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9322 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009323
9324 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9325 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009326 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009327 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9328 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9329 forwarded to this server.
9330
9331 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9332 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9333 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009334 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009335 a single "listen" section.
9336
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009337 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9338 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9339 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9340
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009341 Example :
9342 listen tse-farm
9343 bind :3389
9344 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9345 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9346 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9347 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9348 persist rdp-cookie
9349 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009350 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009351 balance rdp-cookie
9352 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9353 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9354
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009355 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9356 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009357
9358
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009359rate-limit sessions <rate>
9360 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9362 yes | yes | yes | no
9363 Arguments :
9364 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9365 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9366
9367 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9368 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9369 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9370 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9371 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9372 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9373
9374 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9375 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9376 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9377 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9378
9379 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9380 listen smtp
9381 mode tcp
9382 bind :25
9383 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009384 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009385
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009386 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9387 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9388 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009389
9390 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9391
9392
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009393redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9394redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9395redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009396 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9398 no | yes | yes | yes
9399
9400 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009401 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009402
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009403 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009404 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009405 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9406 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9407 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009408
9409 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9410 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9411 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9412 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9413 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009414 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9415 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9416 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9417 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009418
9419 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9420 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9421 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9422 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9423 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9424 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009425 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009426 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009427 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9428 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9429 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009430
9431 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009432 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9433 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9434 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009435 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009436 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9437 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9438 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9439 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009440
9441 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009442 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009443
9444 - "drop-query"
9445 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9446 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9447 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9448 with a location-type redirect.
9449
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009450 - "append-slash"
9451 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9452 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9453 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9454 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9455
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009456 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9457 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9458 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9459 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9460 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9461 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9462 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9463
9464 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9465 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9466 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9467 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9468 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9469 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9470 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009471
9472 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9473 acl clear dst_port 80
9474 acl secure dst_port 8080
9475 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009476 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009477 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009478 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9479
9480 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009481 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9482 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9483 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009484 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009485
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009486 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9487 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9488 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9489
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009490 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009491 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009492
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009493 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009494 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9495 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9496 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009498 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009499
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009500
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009501retries <value>
9502 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9503 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9504 yes | no | yes | yes
9505 Arguments :
9506 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9507 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9508 default value is 3.
9509
9510 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9511 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9512 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9513
9514 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009515 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9516 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009517
9518 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9519 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9520
9521 See also : "option redispatch"
9522
9523
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009524retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009525 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9526 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9527 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009528 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9529 yes | no | yes | yes
9530 Arguments :
9531 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9532 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9533 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9534 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9535
9536 none never retry
9537
9538 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9539 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9540
9541 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9542 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9543 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9544 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9545 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9546 processing the request.
9547
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009548 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9549 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9550 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9551 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9552 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9553 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9554 overflow attack for example).
9555
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009556 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9557 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9558 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9559 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9560 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9561 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9562 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9563 amplify denial of service attacks.
9564
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009565 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9566 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9567 considered to be safe to retry.
9568
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009569 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9570 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9571 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9572 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9573
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009574 all-retryable-errors
9575 retry request for any error that are considered
9576 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9577 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9578 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9579
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009580 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9581 not cumulative.
9582
9583 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9584 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9585 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9586 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9587
9588 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9589 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9590 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9591 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9592 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9593 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9594 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9595 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9596 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9597 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9598 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9599 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9600
9601 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9602 should not use this directive.
9603
9604 The default is "conn-failure".
9605
9606 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9607
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009608server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009609 Declare a server in a backend
9610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9611 no | no | yes | yes
9612 Arguments :
9613 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009614 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009615 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009616
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009617 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9618 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9619 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9620 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009621 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9622 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9623 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9624 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9625 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009626 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9627 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9628 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9629 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9630 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9631 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9632 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009633 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009634 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9635 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9636 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9637 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9638 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9639 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009640 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9641 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009642 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9643 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009644
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009645 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009646 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9647 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9648 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9649 adding this value to the client's port.
9650
9651 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9652 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009653 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009654
9655 Examples :
9656 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9657 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009658 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009659 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9660 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9661 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009662
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009663 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9664 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9665 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9666 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9667 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9668
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009669 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9670 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009671
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009672server-state-file-name [<file>]
9673 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9674 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9675 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9676 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9677 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9678 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9679
9680 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9681 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9682
9683 global
9684 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9685
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009686 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009687 load-server-state-from-file
9688
9689 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9690 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009691
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009692server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9693 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9694 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9696 no | no | yes | yes
9697
9698 Arguments:
9699 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9700
9701 <num | range>
9702 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9703 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9704 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9705 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9706
9707 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9708
9709 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9710
9711 <params*>
9712 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9713 keyword.
9714
9715 Examples:
9716 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9717 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9718 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9719
9720 # or
9721 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9722
9723 # would be equivalent to:
9724 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9725 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9726 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9727
9728
9729
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009730source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009731source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009732source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009733 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9735 yes | no | yes | yes
9736 Arguments :
9737 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9738 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009739
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009740 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009741 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9742 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9743 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9744 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9745 supported prefixes are :
9746 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9747 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9748 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009749 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009750 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9751 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009752
9753 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9754 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009755 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9756 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9757 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009758
9759 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9760 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9761 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9762 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9763 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9764 <addr>.
9765
9766 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9767 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9768 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9769 port.
9770
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009771 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9772 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9773 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9774 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009775 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009776 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9777 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9778 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9779 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9780 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9781 HTTP header.
9782
9783 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9784 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009785 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009786 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9787 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9788 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9789 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9790 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9791 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9792 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9793
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009794 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9795 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9796 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9797 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9798 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9799 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9800
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009801 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9802 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9803 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9804 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9805
9806 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9807 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9808 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9809 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9810 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9811 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9812
9813 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9814 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9815 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9816 there are two methods :
9817
9818 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9819 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9820 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9821 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9822 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9823 of the client ranges may be used.
9824
9825 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9826 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9827 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9828 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9829 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9830 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9831 same session.
9832
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009833 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9834 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9835 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009836 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009837
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009838 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9839
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009840 Examples :
9841 backend private
9842 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9843 source 192.168.1.200
9844
9845 backend transparent_ssl1
9846 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9847 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9848
9849 backend transparent_ssl2
9850 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9851 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9852 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9853
9854 backend transparent_ssl3
9855 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9856 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9857 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9858
9859 backend transparent_smtp
9860 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9861 # with Tproxy version 4.
9862 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9863
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009864 backend transparent_http
9865 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9866 # proxy.
9867 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009869 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009870 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9871
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009872
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009873srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9874 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9875 the connection on the server side.
9876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9877 yes | no | yes | yes
9878 Arguments :
9879 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9880
9881 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9882 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009883 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9884 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009885
9886 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9887
9888
9889srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9890 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9891 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9892 server side.
9893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9894 yes | no | yes | yes
9895 Arguments :
9896 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9897 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9898 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9899 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9900
9901 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9902 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009903 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9904 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009905
9906 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9907
9908
9909srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9910 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9912 yes | no | yes | yes
9913 Arguments :
9914 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9915 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9916 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9917 document.
9918
9919 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9920 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009921 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9922 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009923
9924 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9925
9926
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009927stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9928 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009930 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009931
9932 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9933 matched.
9934
9935 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9936 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9937
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009938 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9939 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009940 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009941
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009942 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9943 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9944 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9945 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009946
9947 Example :
9948 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9949 backend stats_localhost
9950 stats enable
9951 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9952
9953 Example :
9954 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9955 backend stats_auth
9956 stats enable
9957 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9958 stats admin if TRUE
9959
9960 Example :
9961 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9962 userlist stats-auth
9963 group admin users admin
9964 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9965 group readonly users haproxy
9966 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9967
9968 backend stats_auth
9969 stats enable
9970 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9971 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9972 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9973 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9974
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009975 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9976 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9977 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009978
9979
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009980stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9981 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009983 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009984 Arguments :
9985 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9986
9987 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9988
9989 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9990 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9991 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9992 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9993 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9994 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9995
9996 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9997 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9998 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009999 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010000
10001 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10002 report using "stats scope".
10003
10004 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10005 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10006 unobvious parameters.
10007
10008 Example :
10009 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10010 backend public_www
10011 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10012 stats enable
10013 stats hide-version
10014 stats scope .
10015 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010016 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010017 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10018 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10019
10020 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10021 backend private_monitoring
10022 stats enable
10023 stats uri /admin?stats
10024 stats refresh 5s
10025
10026 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10027
10028
10029stats enable
10030 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010032 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010033 Arguments : none
10034
10035 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10036 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10037 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10038 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10039 - stats auth : no authentication
10040 - stats scope : no restriction
10041
10042 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10043 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10044 unobvious parameters.
10045
10046 Example :
10047 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10048 backend public_www
10049 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10050 stats enable
10051 stats hide-version
10052 stats scope .
10053 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010054 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010055 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10056 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10057
10058 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10059 backend private_monitoring
10060 stats enable
10061 stats uri /admin?stats
10062 stats refresh 5s
10063
10064 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10065
10066
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010067stats hide-version
10068 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010070 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010071 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010072
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010073 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10074 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10075 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10076 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10077 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10078 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010079
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010080 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10081 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10082 unobvious parameters.
10083
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010084 Example :
10085 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10086 backend public_www
10087 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010088 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010089 stats hide-version
10090 stats scope .
10091 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010092 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010093 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10094 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010095
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010096 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10097 backend private_monitoring
10098 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010099 stats uri /admin?stats
10100 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010101
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010102 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010103
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010104
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010105stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10106 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10107 Access control for statistics
10108
10109 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10110 no | no | yes | yes
10111
10112 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10113 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10114 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10115 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10116 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10117 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10118
10119 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10120 instance.
10121
10122 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10123 about ACL usage.
10124
10125
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010126stats realm <realm>
10127 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010129 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010130 Arguments :
10131 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10132 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10133 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10134
10135 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10136 using a backslash ('\').
10137
10138 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10139 only related to authentication.
10140
10141 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10142 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10143 unobvious parameters.
10144
10145 Example :
10146 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10147 backend public_www
10148 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10149 stats enable
10150 stats hide-version
10151 stats scope .
10152 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010153 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010154 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10155 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10156
10157 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10158 backend private_monitoring
10159 stats enable
10160 stats uri /admin?stats
10161 stats refresh 5s
10162
10163 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10164
10165
10166stats refresh <delay>
10167 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010169 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010170 Arguments :
10171 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10172 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10173 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10174 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10175 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10176 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10177
10178 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10179 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10180 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010181 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010182
10183 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10184 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10185 unobvious parameters.
10186
10187 Example :
10188 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10189 backend public_www
10190 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10191 stats enable
10192 stats hide-version
10193 stats scope .
10194 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010195 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010196 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10197 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10198
10199 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10200 backend private_monitoring
10201 stats enable
10202 stats uri /admin?stats
10203 stats refresh 5s
10204
10205 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10206
10207
10208stats scope { <name> | "." }
10209 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010211 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010212 Arguments :
10213 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10214 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10215 section in which the statement appears.
10216
10217 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10218 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10219 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10220 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10221 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10222 exists.
10223
10224 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10225 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10226 unobvious parameters.
10227
10228 Example :
10229 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10230 backend public_www
10231 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10232 stats enable
10233 stats hide-version
10234 stats scope .
10235 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010236 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010237 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10238 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10239
10240 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10241 backend private_monitoring
10242 stats enable
10243 stats uri /admin?stats
10244 stats refresh 5s
10245
10246 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10247
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010248
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010249stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010250 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010252 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010253
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010254 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010255 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10256
10257 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10258 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10259
10260 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10261 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010262 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010263
10264 Example :
10265 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10266 backend private_monitoring
10267 stats enable
10268 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10269 stats uri /admin?stats
10270 stats refresh 5s
10271
10272 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10273 global section.
10274
10275
10276stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010277 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10279 yes | yes | yes | yes
10280 Arguments : none
10281
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010282 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010283 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10284 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10285 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10286 - IP (socket, server)
10287 - cookie (backend, server)
10288
10289 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10290 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010291 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010292
10293 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10294
10295
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010296stats show-modules
10297 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10299 yes | yes | yes | yes
10300 Arguments : none
10301
10302 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10303 values as a tooltip.
10304
10305 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10306 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10307 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10308
10309 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10310
10311
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010312stats show-node [ <name> ]
10313 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010315 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010316 Arguments:
10317 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10318 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10319
10320 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10321 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010322 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010323
10324 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10325 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10326 unobvious parameters.
10327
10328 Example:
10329 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10330 backend private_monitoring
10331 stats enable
10332 stats show-node Europe-1
10333 stats uri /admin?stats
10334 stats refresh 5s
10335
10336 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10337 section.
10338
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010339
10340stats uri <prefix>
10341 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010343 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010344 Arguments :
10345 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10346 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10347 query string.
10348
10349 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10350 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10351 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10352 possible to reach it in the application.
10353
10354 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010355 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010356 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10357 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10358 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10359 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10360
10361 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10362 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10363 an address or a port to statistics only.
10364
10365 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10366 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10367 unobvious parameters.
10368
10369 Example :
10370 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10371 backend public_www
10372 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10373 stats enable
10374 stats hide-version
10375 stats scope .
10376 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010377 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010378 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10379 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10380
10381 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10382 backend private_monitoring
10383 stats enable
10384 stats uri /admin?stats
10385 stats refresh 5s
10386
10387 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10388
10389
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010390stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10391 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010393 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010394
10395 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010396 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010397 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010398 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010399 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10400
10401 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10402 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10403 the "stick-table" statement.
10404
10405 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10406 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10407 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10408 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10409 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10410
10411 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10412 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10413 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10414 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10415 transformation rules.
10416
10417 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10418 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10419 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10420 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10421 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10422 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10423 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10424
10425 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10426 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10427 ACL based conditions.
10428
10429 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10430 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10431 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10432 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10433
10434 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10435 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10436 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10437 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10438
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010439 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10440 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010441 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010442
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010443 Example :
10444 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10445 # last 30 minutes
10446 backend pop
10447 mode tcp
10448 balance roundrobin
10449 stick store-request src
10450 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10451 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10452 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10453
10454 backend smtp
10455 mode tcp
10456 balance roundrobin
10457 stick match src table pop
10458 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10459 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10460
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010461 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010462 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010463
10464
10465stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10466 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10468 no | no | yes | yes
10469
10470 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10471 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10472 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10473 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10474
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010475 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10476 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010477 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010478
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010479 Examples :
10480 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010481 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010482
10483 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10484 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10485 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10486
10487
10488 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10489 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10490 backend http
10491 mode http
10492 balance roundrobin
10493 stick on src table https
10494 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10495 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10496 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10497
10498 backend https
10499 mode tcp
10500 balance roundrobin
10501 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10502 stick on src
10503 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10504 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10505
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010506 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010507
10508
10509stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10510 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10512 no | no | yes | yes
10513
10514 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010515 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010516 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010517 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010518 server is selected.
10519
10520 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10521 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10522 the "stick-table" statement.
10523
10524 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10525 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10526 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10527 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10528 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10529 address.
10530
10531 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10532 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10533 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10534 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10535 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10536 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10537 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10538 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10539 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10540 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10541
10542 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10543 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10544 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10545 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10546 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10547 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10548 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10549
10550 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10551 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10552 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10553 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10554
10555 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10556 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10557 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10558 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10559 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10560 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010561 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10562 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10563 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10564 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10565 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10566 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010567
10568 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10569 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10570 the request.
10571
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010572 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10573 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010574 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010575
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010576 Example :
10577 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10578 # last 30 minutes
10579 backend pop
10580 mode tcp
10581 balance roundrobin
10582 stick store-request src
10583 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10584 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10585 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10586
10587 backend smtp
10588 mode tcp
10589 balance roundrobin
10590 stick match src table pop
10591 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10592 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10593
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010594 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010595 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010596
10597
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010598stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010599 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10600 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010601 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010603 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010604
10605 Arguments :
10606 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10607 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10608 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10609 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10610
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010611 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10612 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10613 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10614 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10615
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010616 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10617 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10618 instance.
10619
10620 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10621 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10622 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10623 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10624 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10625 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010626 to 32 characters.
10627
10628 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10629 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10630 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010631 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010632 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10633 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010634
10635 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010636 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10637 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010638 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10639 increase.
10640
10641 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010642 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10643 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10644 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010645
10646 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10647 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10648 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10649 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010650 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010651 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10652 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10653 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10654 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10655 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10656 parameter (see below).
10657
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010658 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10659 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10660 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10661 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10662 soft restart.
10663
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010664 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10665 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010666
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010667 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10668 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10669 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10670 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010671 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010672 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010673 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10674 if not expiration delay is specified.
10675
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010676 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10677 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10678 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10679 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010680 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10681 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10682 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10683 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10684 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10685 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10686 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10687 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10688 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10689 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10690 types and their arguments.
10691
10692 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10693 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10694 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10695 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10696
10697 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10698 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10699 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010700 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010701
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010702 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10703 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10704 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010705 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010706 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010707 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010708
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010709 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10710 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10711 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10712 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10713
10714 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10715 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10716 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10717 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10718 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10719 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10720
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010721 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10722 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10723 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10724 they were received.
10725
10726 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10727 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10728 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10729 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10730 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10731
10732 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10733 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10734 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10735 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10736 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10737
10738 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10739 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10740 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10741
10742 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10743 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10744 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10745 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10746 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10747
10748 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10749 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10750 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10751 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10752 the client side.
10753
10754 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10755 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10756 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10757 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10758 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10759 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10760 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10761
10762 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10763 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10764 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10765 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10766 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10767 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010768 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010769
10770 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10771 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10772 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10773 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10774 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10775 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10776
10777 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010778 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010779 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10780 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10781
10782 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10783 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10784 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10785 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10786 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10787 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10788 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10789 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10790 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10791 recommended for better fairness.
10792
10793 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010794 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010795 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10796 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10797
10798 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10799 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10800 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10801 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10802 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10803 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10804 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10805 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10806 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10807 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010808
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010809 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10810 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010811 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10812 reference it.
10813
10814 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10815 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010816 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10817 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10818 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010819
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010820 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10821 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10822 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10823 something that can be ignored.
10824
10825 Example:
10826 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10827 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10828 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10829 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10830
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010831 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010832 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010833
10834
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010835stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010836 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10838 no | no | yes | yes
10839
10840 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010841 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010842 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010843 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010844 server is selected.
10845
10846 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10847 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10848 the "stick-table" statement.
10849
10850 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10851 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10852 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10853 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10854
10855 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10856 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10857 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10858 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10859 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10860 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010861 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010862 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10863 rules.
10864
10865 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10866 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10867 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10868 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10869 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10870 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10871 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10872
10873 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10874 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10875 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10876 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10877
10878 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10879 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10880 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10881 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10882 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10883 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010884 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10885 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10886 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10887 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10888 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10889 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10890 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10891 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10892 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010893
10894 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10895
10896 Example :
10897 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10898 backend https
10899 mode tcp
10900 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010901 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010902 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010903
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010904 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10905 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10906
10907 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10908 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10909 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10910
10911 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10912 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010913
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010914 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10915 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10916 # at offset 44.
10917
10918 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10919 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10920
10921 # Learn on response if server hello.
10922 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010923
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010924 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10925 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10926
10927 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10928 extraction.
10929
10930
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010931tcp-check comment <string>
10932 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10933 it fails.
10934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10935 yes | no | yes | yes
10936
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010937 Arguments :
10938 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10939 rule fails.
10940
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010941 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10942 user-friendly error reporting.
10943
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010944 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10945 "tcp-check expect".
10946
10947
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010948tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10949 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010950 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010951 Opens a new connection
10952 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010953 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010954
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010955 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010956 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10957
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010958 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010959 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010960
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010961 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010962 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10963 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010964 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010965
10966 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010967
10968 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10969
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010970 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10971
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010972 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10973
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010974 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10975
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010976 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10977 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10978 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10979 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10980
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010981 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10982 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10983 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10984 haproxy -vv.
10985
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010986 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010987
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010988 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10989 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10990 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10991
10992 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10993 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10994 of the sequence.
10995
10996 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10997 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10998 do.
10999
11000 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11001 unset-var or comment rules.
11002
11003 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011004 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11005 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11006 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11007 option tcp-check
11008 tcp-check connect
11009 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11010 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11011 tcp-check send \r\n
11012 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11013 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11014 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11015 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11016 tcp-check send \r\n
11017 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11018 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11019
11020 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11021 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011022 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011023 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11024 tcp-check connect port 143
11025 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11026 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11027
11028 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11029
11030
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011031tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011032 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011033 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011034 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011035 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011036 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011037 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011038
11039 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011040 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11041
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011042 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11043 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11044 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11045 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11046 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11047 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11048 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11049 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11050 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11051 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11052
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011053 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011054 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11055 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011056 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11057 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11058 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11059
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011060 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11061 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11062 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011063 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11064 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
11065 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
11066 example 404 with disable-on-404
11067 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11068 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011069 By default "L7OK" is used.
11070
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011071 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11072 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011073 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
11074 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11075 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11076 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11077 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11078 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011079
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011080 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011081 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011082 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11083 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11084 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11085 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011086 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11087
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011088 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11089 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11090 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11091 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11092
11093 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11094 informational message reported in logs if an error
11095 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11096 log-format string.
11097
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011098 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11099 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11100 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11101 followed by some converters.
11102
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011103 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11104 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11105 with the usual backslash ('\').
11106 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011107 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011108 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11109 used upper or lower case.
11110
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011111 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11112
11113 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11114 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11115 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11116 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11117 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11118 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11119 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11120 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11121
11122 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11123 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11124 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11125 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11126 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11127 expression.
11128
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011129 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11130 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11131 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11132 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11133 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11134 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11135
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011136 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11137 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11138 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11139 this exact hexadecimal string.
11140 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11141
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011142 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11143 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11144 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11145 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11146 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11147 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11148 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11149 size.
11150
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011151 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11152 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11153 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11154 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11155 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11156 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11157 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11158 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11159 in a binary string before matching the response's
11160 buffer.
11161
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011162 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
11163 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
11164 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11165 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11166 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11167 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11168 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11169 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11170 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11171 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11172 the null character.
11173
11174 Examples :
11175 # perform a POP check
11176 option tcp-check
11177 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11178
11179 # perform an IMAP check
11180 option tcp-check
11181 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11182
11183 # look for the redis master server
11184 option tcp-check
11185 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011186 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011187 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11188 tcp-check expect string role:master
11189 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11190 tcp-check expect string +OK
11191
11192
11193 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
11194 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
11195
11196
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011197tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11198tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11199 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11200 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011201 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011202 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011203
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011204 Arguments :
11205 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11206
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011207 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11208 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011209
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011210 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11211 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011212
11213 Examples :
11214 # look for the redis master server
11215 option tcp-check
11216 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11217 tcp-check expect string role:master
11218
11219 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
11220 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
11221
11222
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011223tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11224tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11225 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11226 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011227 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011228 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011229
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011230 Arguments :
11231 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011232
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011233 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11234 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011235
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011236 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11237 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11238 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011239
11240 Examples :
11241 # redis check in binary
11242 option tcp-check
11243 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11244 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11245
11246
11247 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
11248 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
11249
11250
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011251tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011252 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011253 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011254 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011255
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011256 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011257 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11258 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11259 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11260 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11261 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11262 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11263 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11264 and '-'.
11265
11266 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11267
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011268 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011269 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11270
11271
11272tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011273 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011274 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011275 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011276
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011277 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011278 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11279 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11280 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11281 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11282 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11283 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11284 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11285 and '-'.
11286
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011287 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011288 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11289
11290
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011291tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11292 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11294 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011295 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011296 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11297 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011298
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011299 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011300
11301 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11302 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011303 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11304 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11305 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11306 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11307 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11308 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011309
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011310 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11311 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11312 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11313 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011314
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011315 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011316 - accept :
11317 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11318 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11319 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011320
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011321 - reject :
11322 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11323 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11324 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11325 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11326 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11327 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11328 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11329 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11330 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11331 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11332 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011333 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011334
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011335 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11336 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11337 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11338 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11339 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11340 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11341 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11342 hosts.
11343
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011344 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11345 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11346 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11347 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11348 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11349 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11350 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11351 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11352
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011353 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11354 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11355 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11356 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11357 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11358 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11359 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11360 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11361 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011362 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11363 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011364
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011365 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011366 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011367 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11368 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11369 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011370 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011371 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011372 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11373 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11374 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11375 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11376 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11377 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11378 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011379
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011380 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011381 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011382 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011383 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011384 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11385 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11386 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011387
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011388 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11389 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11390 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11391 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011392
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011393 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11394 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11395 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11396 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11397 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011398 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11399 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11400 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11401 layer7 information is extracted.
11402
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011403 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11404 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11405 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11406 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11407 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011408
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011409 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11410 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11411 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11412 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11413
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011414 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11415 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11416 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11417 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11418
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011419 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11420 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11421 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11422 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11423 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011424
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011425 - set-src <expr> :
11426 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11427 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11428 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011429 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011430
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011431 Arguments:
11432 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11433 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011434
11435 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011436 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11437
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011438 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11439 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011440
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011441 - set-src-port <expr> :
11442 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11443 expression.
11444
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011445 Arguments:
11446 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11447 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011448
11449 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011450 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11451
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011452 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11453 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11454 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011455
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011456 - set-dst <expr> :
11457 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11458 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11459 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11460 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11461 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11462
11463 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11464 followed by some converters.
11465
11466 Example:
11467
11468 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11469 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11470
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011471 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11472 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11473
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011474 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11475 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11476 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11477 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11478
11479
11480 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11481 followed by some converters.
11482
11483 Example:
11484
11485 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11486
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011487 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11488 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11489 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11490
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011491 - "silent-drop" :
11492 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011493 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011494 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11495 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11496 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11497 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11498 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011499 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11500 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011501 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11502 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011503 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011504 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11505 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11506 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11507 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11508
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011509 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11510 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11511 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011512
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011513 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11514 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11515 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011516
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011517 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011518 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011519 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011520
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011521 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11522 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11523 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011524
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011525 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011526 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11527 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011528
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011529 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11530
11531 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11532
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011533 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11534
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011535 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011536
11537
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011538tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11539 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011541 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011542 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011543 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11544 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011545
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011546 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011547
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011548 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011549 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11550 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11551 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11552 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011553
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011554 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11555 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11556 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11557 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011558 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11559 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11560 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11561 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11562 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11563 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011564 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011565 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011566
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011567 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11568 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11569 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11570 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011571
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011572 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011573 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011574 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011575 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11576 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011577 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011578 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011579 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011580 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011581 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011582 - set-dst <expr>
11583 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011584 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011585 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011586 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011587 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011588 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011589
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011590 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11591 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011592 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11593 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011594
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011595 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11596 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11597 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11598 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11599 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11600 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011601
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011602 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011603 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11604 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011605
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011606 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11607 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11608 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11609 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11610 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11611 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11612
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011613 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011614 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11615 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11616 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11617 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11618 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11619 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11620 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11621 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11622 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11623 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011624
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011625 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011626 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11627 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11628 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011629
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011630 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11631 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11632
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011633 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011634 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11635 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011636
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011637 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11638 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011639 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011640 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11641 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011642 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011643 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011644 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011645 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11646 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011647 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011648 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11649 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011650
11651 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11652 followed by some converters.
11653
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011654 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11655 <var-name>.
11656
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011657 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11658 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11659 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11660 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11661 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11662
11663 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11664 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11665 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11666 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11667 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11668 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11669 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11670 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11671 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11672 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11673 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11674
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011675 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11676 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11677 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11678 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11679 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11680
11681 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11682
11683 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11684
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011685 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11686 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11687 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11688 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11689 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11690 evaluated.
11691
11692 Example:
11693 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11694
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011695 Example:
11696
11697 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011698 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011699
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011700 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011701 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11702 # and reject everything else.
11703 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11704 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011705 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011706 tcp-request content reject
11707
11708 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011709 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11710 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11711 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011712 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011713
11714 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11715 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11716 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011717 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011718 tcp-request content reject
11719
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011720 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011721 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011722 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011723 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011724 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11725 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011726
11727 Example:
11728 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11729 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011730 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011731
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011732 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011733 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011734
11735 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011736 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011737 # protecting all our sites
11738 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011739 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11740 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011741 ...
11742 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11743
11744 backend http_dynamic
11745 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011746 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011747 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011748 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011749 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011750 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011751 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011752
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011753 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011754
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011755 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11756 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011757
11758
11759tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11760 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011762 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011763 Arguments :
11764 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11765 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11766 as explained at the top of this document.
11767
11768 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11769 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11770 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11771 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11772 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11773
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011774 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11775 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11776 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11777 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11778
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011779 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11780 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011781 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011782 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011783 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11784 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11785 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11786 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011787
11788 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11789 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11790 it pass through unaffected.
11791
11792 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11793 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11794 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011795 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011796 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11797 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011798 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11799 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11800 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011801
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011802 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011803 "timeout client".
11804
11805
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011806tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11807 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11809 no | no | yes | yes
11810 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011811 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11812 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011813
11814 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11815
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011816 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011817 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11818 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011819 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11820 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011821
11822 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11823
11824 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11825 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11826 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11827 inserted.
11828
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011829 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011830 - accept :
11831 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11832 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11833 the rules evaluation.
11834
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011835 - close :
11836 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11837 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11838 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11839 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11840 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11841 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011842 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011843 protocols.
11844
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011845 - reject :
11846 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11847 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011848 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011849
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011850 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11851 Sets a variable.
11852
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011853 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11854 Unsets a variable.
11855
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011856 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11857 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11858 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11859 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11860
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011861 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11862 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11863 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11864 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11865
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011866 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11867 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11868 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11869 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11870 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011871
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011872 - "silent-drop" :
11873 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011874 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011875 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11876 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11877 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11878 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11879 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011880 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11881 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011882 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11883 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011884 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011885 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11886 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11887 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11888 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11889
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011890 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11891 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11892
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011893 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11894 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11895 for changing the default action to a reject.
11896
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011897 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11898 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11899 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11900 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011901 period.
11902
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011903 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11904 declared inline.
11905
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011906 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11907 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011908 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011909 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11910 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011911 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011912 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011913 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011914 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11915 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011916 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011917 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11918 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011919
11920 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11921 followed by some converters.
11922
11923 Example:
11924
11925 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11926
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011927 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11928 <var-name>.
11929
11930 Example:
11931
11932 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11933
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011934 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11935 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11936 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11937 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11938 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11939
11940 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11941
11942 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11943
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011944 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11945
11946 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11947
11948
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011949tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11950 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11952 no | yes | yes | no
11953 Arguments :
11954 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11955 below.
11956
11957 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11958
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011959 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011960 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11961 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11962 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11963 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11964 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11965 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11966 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011967 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011968 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11969 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11970 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11971 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11972 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11973 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11974 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11975 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11976 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11977 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11978 instead.
11979
11980 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11981 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11982 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11983 rules which may be inserted.
11984
11985 Several types of actions are supported :
11986 - accept : the request is accepted
11987 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11988 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11989 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011990 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011991 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011992 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011993 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011994 - silent-drop
11995
11996 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11997 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11998 sections for a complete description.
11999
12000 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12001 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12002 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12003
12004 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12005 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12006 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12007 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12008 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12009
12010 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12011 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12012
12013 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12014 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12015 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12016
12017 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12018 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12019 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12020
12021 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12022 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12023 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12024
12025 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12026 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12027 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12028
12029 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12030
12031 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12032
12033
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012034tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12035 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12037 no | no | yes | yes
12038 Arguments :
12039 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12040 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12041 as explained at the top of this document.
12042
12043 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12044
12045
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012046timeout check <timeout>
12047 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12048 established.
12049
12050 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12051 yes | no | yes | yes
12052 Arguments:
12053 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12054 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12055 as explained at the top of this document.
12056
12057 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12058 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012059 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012060 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012061 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12062 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12063 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012064
12065 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12066 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12067
12068 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12069 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012070 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012071
12072 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12073 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12074 forget about it.
12075
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012076 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12077 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012078
12079
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012080timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012081 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12083 yes | yes | yes | no
12084 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012085 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012086 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12087 as explained at the top of this document.
12088
12089 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12090 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12091 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012092 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12093 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12094 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12095 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012096 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12097 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12098 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012099 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012100 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012101 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12102 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012103 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12104 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012105
12106 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12107 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12108 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12109 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012110 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012111 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12112
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012113 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012114
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012115 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012116
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012117
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012118timeout client-fin <timeout>
12119 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12121 yes | yes | yes | no
12122 Arguments :
12123 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12124 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12125 as explained at the top of this document.
12126
12127 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12128 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12129 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12130 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12131 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12132 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12133 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012134 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12135 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12136 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012137
12138 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12139 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12140 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12141
12142 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12143
12144
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012145timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012146 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12148 yes | no | yes | yes
12149 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012150 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012151 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12152 as explained at the top of this document.
12153
12154 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012155 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012156 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012157 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012158 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12159 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012160
12161 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12162 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12163 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12164 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012165 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012166 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12167
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012168 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012169
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012170
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012171timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12172 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12174 yes | yes | yes | yes
12175 Arguments :
12176 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12177 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12178 as explained at the top of this document.
12179
12180 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12181 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12182 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12183 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12184 once the request has started to present itself.
12185
12186 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12187 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12188 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12189 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12190 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12191
12192 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12193 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12194 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12195 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12196
12197 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12198 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012199 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012200 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12201 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012202 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012203
12204 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12205 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12206 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12207 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12208
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012209 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12210 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012211 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12212
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012213 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12214
12215
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012216timeout http-request <timeout>
12217 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012219 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012220 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012221 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012222 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12223 as explained at the top of this document.
12224
12225 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12226 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12227 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12228 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12229 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12230 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12231 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012232 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12233 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12234 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12235 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012236 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012237 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12238 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012239
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012240 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12241 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12242 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12243 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12244 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012245 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012246
12247 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12248 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012249 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012250 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12251 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12252
12253 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012254 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12255 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12256 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012257
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012258 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012259 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012260
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012261
12262timeout queue <timeout>
12263 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12265 yes | no | yes | yes
12266 Arguments :
12267 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12268 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12269 as explained at the top of this document.
12270
12271 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12272 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12273 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12274 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12275 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12276
12277 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12278 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12279 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12280 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12281
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012282 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012283
12284
12285timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012286 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12288 yes | no | yes | yes
12289 Arguments :
12290 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12291 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12292 as explained at the top of this document.
12293
12294 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12295 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12296 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12297 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12298 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12299 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12300 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12301
12302 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12303 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12304 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12305 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12306 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012307 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012308 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012309 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12310 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012311 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12312 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012313
12314 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12315 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12316 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12317 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012318 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012319 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12320
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012321 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012322
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012323
12324timeout server-fin <timeout>
12325 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12327 yes | no | yes | yes
12328 Arguments :
12329 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12330 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12331 as explained at the top of this document.
12332
12333 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12334 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12335 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12336 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12337 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12338 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12339 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12340 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12341 situations, it should not be needed.
12342
12343 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12344 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12345 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12346
12347 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12348
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012349
12350timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012351 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12353 yes | yes | yes | yes
12354 Arguments :
12355 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12356 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12357 as explained at the top of this document.
12358
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012359 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12360 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12361 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012362
12363 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12364 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12365 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12366 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012367 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012368
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012369 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012370
12371
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012372timeout tunnel <timeout>
12373 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12375 yes | no | yes | yes
12376 Arguments :
12377 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12378 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12379 as explained at the top of this document.
12380
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012381 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012382 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12383 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12384 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012385 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12386 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012387 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12388 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12389 specified.
12390
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012391 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12392 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12393 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12394 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12395 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12396 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12397 state.
12398
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012399 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12400 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12401 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12402 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012403 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012404
12405 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12406 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12407 forget about it.
12408
12409 Example :
12410 defaults http
12411 option http-server-close
12412 timeout connect 5s
12413 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012414 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012415 timeout server 30s
12416 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12417
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012418 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012419
12420
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012421transparent (deprecated)
12422 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012424 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012425 Arguments : none
12426
12427 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12428 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12429 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12430 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12431 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12432 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12433 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12434 appropriate server.
12435
12436 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12437
12438 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12439 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12440
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012441 See also: "option transparent"
12442
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012443unique-id-format <string>
12444 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12446 yes | yes | yes | no
12447 Arguments :
12448 <string> is a log-format string.
12449
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012450 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12451 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12452 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12453 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012454
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012455 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12456 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12457 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12458 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12459 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12460 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12461 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12462 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012463
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012464 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12465 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012466
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012467 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012468
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012469 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012470
12471 will generate:
12472
12473 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12474
12475 See also: "unique-id-header"
12476
12477unique-id-header <name>
12478 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12480 yes | yes | yes | no
12481 Arguments :
12482 <name> is the name of the header.
12483
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012484 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12485 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012486
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012487 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012488
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012489 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012490 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12491
12492 will generate:
12493
12494 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12495
12496 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012497
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012498use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012499 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12501 no | yes | yes | no
12502 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012503 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12504 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012505
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012506 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12507 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012508
12509 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12510 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12511 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012512 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012513 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012514 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12515 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012516
12517 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12518 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12519 assign the backend.
12520
12521 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12522 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12523 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12524 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12525 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12526 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12527
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012528 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012529 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012530 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12531 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12532 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12533
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012534 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12535 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12536 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12537 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12538 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12539 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12540 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12541 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12542 cannot be forced from the request.
12543
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012544 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012545 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12546 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12547
12548 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12549 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012550
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012551use-fcgi-app <name>
12552 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12554 no | no | yes | yes
12555 Arguments :
12556 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12557
12558 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012559
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012560use-server <server> if <condition>
12561use-server <server> unless <condition>
12562 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12564 no | no | yes | yes
12565 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012566 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12567 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012568
12569 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12570
12571 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12572 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12573 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12574
12575 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12576 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12577 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12578 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12579 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12580 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12581 matches will assign the server.
12582
12583 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12584 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12585 with the next rules until one matches.
12586
12587 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12588 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12589 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12590 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12591
12592 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12593 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12594 stripped.
12595
12596 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12597 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012598 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12599 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12600 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012601
12602 Example :
12603 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12604 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12605 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12606 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012607 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012608 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012609 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012610 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12611 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12612
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012613 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12614 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12615 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12616 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012617 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012618 and we fall back to load balancing.
12619
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012620 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012621
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012622
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100126235. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012624--------------------------
12625
12626The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12627depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12628settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12629written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12630described in this section.
12631
12632
126335.1. Bind options
12634-----------------
12635
12636The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12637as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12638no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12639parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12640while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12641provided immediately after the setting name.
12642
12643The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12644
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012645accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12646 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12647 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12648 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12649 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12650 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12651 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12652 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12653 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12654 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012655 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12656 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12657 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012658
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012659accept-proxy
12660 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012661 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12662 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012663 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12664 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12665 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12666 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012667 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012668 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12669 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012670 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12671 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012672
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012673allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012674 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012675 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012676 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012677 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12678 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012679
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012680alpn <protocols>
12681 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12682 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12683 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012684 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012685 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012686 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12687 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12688 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12689 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12690 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12691 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12692 preference, like below :
12693
12694 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012695
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012696backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012697 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012698 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12699
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012700curves <curves>
12701 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12702 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12703 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12704 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12705 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12706 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12707
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012708ecdhe <named curve>
12709 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012710 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12711 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012712
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012713ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012714 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12715 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12716 client's certificate.
12717
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012718ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12719 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12720 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12721 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12722 error is ignored.
12723
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012724ca-sign-file <cafile>
12725 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12726 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12727 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12728 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12729 'generate-certificates' for details.
12730
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012731ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012732 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12733 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12734 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12735 'generate-certificates' for details.
12736
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012737ca-verify-file <cafile>
12738 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12739 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12740 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12741 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12742 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12743
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012744ciphers <ciphers>
12745 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12746 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012747 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012748 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012749 information and recommendations see e.g.
12750 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12751 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12752 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12753
12754ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12755 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12756 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12757 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12758 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012759 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12760 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012761
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012762crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012763 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12764 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12765 to verify client's certificate.
12766
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012767crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012768 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12769 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12770 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12771 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12772 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012773 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12774 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012775
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012776 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12777 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12778
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012779 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12780 are loaded.
12781
12782 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012783 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12784 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12785 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12786 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12787 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12788 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12789 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012790 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012791
12792 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12793 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12794 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12795 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012796 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12797 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012798
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012799 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012800
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012801 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012802 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012803 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12804 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012805 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12806 clients).
12807
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012808 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12809 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12810 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12811 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12812 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12813 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12814 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12815 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12816 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12817 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12818 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12819 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12820 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12821
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012822 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12823 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12824 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12825 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12826 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12827
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012828 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12829 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12830 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12831 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012832
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012833 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
12834 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
12835 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012836
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012837crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012838 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012839 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012840 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012841 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012842
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012843crt-list <file>
12844 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012845 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12846 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012847
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012848 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12849
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012850 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12851 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12852 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12853 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12854 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012855
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012856 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraiscaaa46c2020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012857 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
12858 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
12859 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
12860 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
12861 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012862 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12863 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12864 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012865
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012866 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
12867 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
12868 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012869
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012870 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12871
Joao Morais5ae6bfc2020-11-24 08:24:30 -030012872 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
12873 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
12874 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
12875 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
12876 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
12877 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
12878 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
12879 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraiscaaa46c2020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012880
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012881 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraiscaaa46c2020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012882 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012883 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012884 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012885 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012886 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012887
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012888defer-accept
12889 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12890 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12891 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012892 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012893 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12894 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12895 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12896 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12897 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12898 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12899 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12900
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012901expose-fd listeners
12902 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12903 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012904 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12905 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012906 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012907
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012908force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012909 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012910 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012911 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012912 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012913
12914force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012915 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012916 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012917 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012918
12919force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012920 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012921 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012922 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012923
12924force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012925 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012926 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012927 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012928
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012929force-tlsv13
12930 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12931 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012932 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012933
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012934generate-certificates
12935 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12936 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12937 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12938 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12939 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12940 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12941 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12942 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12943 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12944 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12945 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12946
12947 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12948 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012949 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012950 certificate is used many times.
12951
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012952gid <gid>
12953 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12954 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12955 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12956 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12957 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12958
12959group <group>
12960 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12961 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12962 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12963 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12964 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12965
12966id <id>
12967 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12968 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12969 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12970 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12971
12972interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012973 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12974 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12975 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12976 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12977 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12978 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012979 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12980 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12981 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12982 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12983 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12984 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012985
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012986level <level>
12987 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12988 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12989 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012990 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012991 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12992 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12993 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012994 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012995 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012996 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012997 all counters).
12998
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012999severity-output <format>
13000 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13001 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13002 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13003 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13004 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13005 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13006 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13007 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13008 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13009 rfc5424 convention.
13010
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013011maxconn <maxconn>
13012 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13013 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13014 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13015 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13016 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13017 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13018 eat all memory.
13019
13020mode <mode>
13021 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13022 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13023 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13024 UNIX sockets.
13025
13026mss <maxseg>
13027 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13028 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13029 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13030 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13031 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13032 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13033 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13034 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13035 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13036 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13037 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13038
13039name <name>
13040 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13041 page.
13042
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013043namespace <name>
13044 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13045 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13046 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13047 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13048
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013049nice <nice>
13050 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13051 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13052 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13053 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13054 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13055 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13056 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13057 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13058 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13059 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13060 one for an RDP socket.
13061
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013062no-ca-names
13063 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13064 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013065 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013066
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013067no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013068 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013069 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013070 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013071 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013072 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13073 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013074
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013075no-tls-tickets
13076 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13077 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13078 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013079 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13080 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013081 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13082 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13083 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013084
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013085no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013086 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013087 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013088 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013089 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013090 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13091 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013092
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013093no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013094 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013095 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013096 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013097 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013098 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13099 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013100
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013101no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013102 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013103 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013104 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013105 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013106 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13107 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013108
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013109no-tlsv13
13110 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13111 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13112 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13113 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013114 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13115 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013116
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013117npn <protocols>
13118 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13119 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13120 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013121 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013122 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013123 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13124 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13125 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13126 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13127 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013128
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013129prefer-client-ciphers
13130 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13131 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13132 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013133 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13134 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13135 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013136
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013137process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013138 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013139 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013140 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013141 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13142 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13143 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13144 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013145 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013146 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13147 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13148 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13149 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13150 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013151
13152 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13153
13154 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13155 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13156 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13157 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13158 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13159 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13160 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13161 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013162
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013163proto <name>
13164 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13165 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13166 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
13167 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013168 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013169 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013170 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013171 h2" on the bind line.
13172
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013173ssl
13174 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013175 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013176 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13177 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013178 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13179 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013180
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013181ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13182 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013183 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13184 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13185 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013186 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13187
13188ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013189 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13190 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13191 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13192 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013193
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013194strict-sni
13195 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13196 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13197 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13198 See the "crt" option for more information.
13199
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013200tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013201 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013202 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13203 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013204 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013205 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13206 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13207 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13208 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13209 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13210 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13211 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13212
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013213tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013214 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013215 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13216 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13217 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13218 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13219 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13220 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13221 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013222 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13223 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13224 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013225
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013226tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13227 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013228 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13229 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13230 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13231 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13232 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13233 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13234 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13235 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13236 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13237 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013238 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13239 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13240
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013241transparent
13242 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13243 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13244 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13245 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13246 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13247 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13248 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13249 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13250 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13251 so check for support with your vendor.
13252
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013253v4v6
13254 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13255 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13256 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13257 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013258 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013259
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013260v6only
13261 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13262 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13263 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013264 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13265 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013266
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013267uid <uid>
13268 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13269 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13270 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13271 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13272 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13273
13274user <user>
13275 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13276 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13277 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13278 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13279 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13280
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013281verify [none|optional|required]
13282 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13283 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13284 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13285 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13286 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013287 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13288 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13289 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13290 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013291
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200132925.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013293------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013294
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013295The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13296which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13297arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13298settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13299after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13300Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13301address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013303 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013304 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013305
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013306Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13307keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13308
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013309The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013310
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013311addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013312 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013313 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13314 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13315 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13316 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13317 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013318
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013319agent-check
13320 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013321 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013322 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13323 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13324 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013325
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013326 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013327 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013328 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13329 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13330 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013332 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13333 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13334 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13335 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13336 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013337
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013338 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013339 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013340
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013341 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13342 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13343 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013344
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013345 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13346 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13347 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013348
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013349 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013350 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13351 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13352 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13353 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013354 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013355 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013356
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013357 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13358 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013359
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013360 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13361 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13362 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13363 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13364 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13365 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13366 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13367 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13368 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013369
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013370 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13371 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013372 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13373 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13374 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013375 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013376
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013377 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013378 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013379
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013380agent-send <string>
13381 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13382 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13383 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13384 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13385 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13386
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013387agent-inter <delay>
13388 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13389 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13390
13391 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13392 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13393 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13394 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13395 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13396 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13397 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13398 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13399 of backends use the same servers.
13400
13401 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13402
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013403agent-addr <addr>
13404 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13405
13406 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13407 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13408 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13409 hostname, it will be resolved.
13410
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013411agent-port <port>
13412 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13413
13414 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13415
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013416allow-0rtt
13417 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013418 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13419 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013420
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013421alpn <protocols>
13422 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13423 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13424 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013425 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013426 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13427 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13428 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13429 now obsolete NPN extension.
13430 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13431 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13432
13433 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13434
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013435backup
13436 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13437 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13438 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13439 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013440 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13441 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013442
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013443ca-file <cafile>
13444 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13445 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13446 server's certificate.
13447
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013448check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013449 This option enables health checks on a server:
13450 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13451 considered available.
13452 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13453 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13454 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13455 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13456 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13457 set.
13458 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13459 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13460 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13461 exchanges succeed.
13462
13463 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13464 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13465 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13466 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13467 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013468 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013469 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13470
13471 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13472 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13473
13474 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13475 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13476
13477 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13478 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13479 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13480 available.
13481
13482 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13483 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13484 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13485
13486 Example:
13487 # simple tcp check
13488 backend foo
13489 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13490 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13491 backend foo
13492 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13493 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13494 backend foo
13495 option tcp-check
13496 tcp-check connect
13497 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013498
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013499check-send-proxy
13500 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13501 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13502 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13503 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13504 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13505 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13506 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13507
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013508check-alpn <protocols>
13509 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13510 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13511 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13512
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013513check-proto <name>
13514 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13515 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13516 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13517 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013518 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013519 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13520 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13521
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013522check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013523 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013524 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13525 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013526
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013527check-ssl
13528 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13529 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13530 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13531 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013532 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013533 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13534 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013535 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013536 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13537 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013538
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013539check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013540 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013541 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13542 for normal traffic.
13543
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013544ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013545 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13546 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13547 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013548 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13549 information and recommendations see e.g.
13550 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13551 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13552 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013553
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013554ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13555 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13556 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13557 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13558 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013559 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13560 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13561 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013563cookie <value>
13564 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13565 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13566 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13567 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13568 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13569 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13570 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13571
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013572crl-file <crlfile>
13573 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13574 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13575 to verify server's certificate.
13576
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013577crt <cert>
13578 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13579 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13580 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13581 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13582 certificate request.
13583
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013584disabled
13585 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13586 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13587 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13588 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13589 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013590 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013591
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013592enabled
13593 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13594 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13595 default value.
13596 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13597 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013598
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013599error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013600 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13601 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13602 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013603
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013604 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013605
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013606fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013607 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13608 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13609 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13610
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013611force-sslv3
13612 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13613 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013614 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013615 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013616
13617force-tlsv10
13618 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013619 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013620 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013621
13622force-tlsv11
13623 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013624 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013625 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013626
13627force-tlsv12
13628 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013629 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013630 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013631
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013632force-tlsv13
13633 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13634 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013635 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013636
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013637id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013638 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13639 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13640 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013641
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013642init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13643 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13644 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013645 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013646 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13647 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13648 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13649 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13650 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13651 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13652 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13653 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13654 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013655 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013656 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13657 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13658 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13659 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13660 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13661 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013662 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013663
13664 Example:
13665 defaults
13666 # never fail on address resolution
13667 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13668
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013669inter <delay>
13670fastinter <delay>
13671downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013672 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13673 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13674 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13675 between checks depending on the server state :
13676
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013677 Server state | Interval used
13678 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13679 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13680 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13681 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13682 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13683 or yet unchecked. |
13684 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13685 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13686 | "inter" otherwise.
13687 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013688
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013689 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13690 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13691 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13692 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013693 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13694 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13695 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13696 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13697 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013698
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013699log-proto <logproto>
13700 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13701 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13702 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13703 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13704
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013705maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013706 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13707 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013708 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13709 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013710 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13711 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13712 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13713 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13714
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013715 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13716 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13717 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13718 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13719 than 50 concurrent requests.
13720
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013721maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013722 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13723 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13724 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13725 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020013726 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
13727 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
13728 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
13729 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
13730 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
13731 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
13732 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013733
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013734max-reuse <count>
13735 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13736 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13737 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13738 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13739 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13740 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13741 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13742 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13743
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013744minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013745 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13746 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13747 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13748 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13749 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13750 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013751 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013752 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013753
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013754namespace <name>
13755 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13756 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13757 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13758 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13759
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013760no-agent-check
13761 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13762 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13763 default value.
13764 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13765 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13766
13767no-backup
13768 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13769 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13770 default value.
13771 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13772 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13773
13774no-check
13775 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13776 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13777 default value.
13778 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13779 "default-server" "check" setting.
13780
13781no-check-ssl
13782 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13783 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13784 default value.
13785 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13786 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13787
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013788no-send-proxy
13789 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13790 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13791 default value.
13792 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13793 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13794
13795no-send-proxy-v2
13796 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13797 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13798 default value.
13799 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13800 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13801
13802no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13803 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13804 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13805 default value.
13806 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13807 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13808
13809no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13810 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13811 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13812 default value.
13813 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13814 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13815
13816no-ssl
13817 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13818 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13819 default value.
13820 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13821 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13822
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013823no-ssl-reuse
13824 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13825 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13826 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13827 and for paranoid users.
13828
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013829no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013830 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13831 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013832 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013833
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013834 Supported in default-server: No
13835
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013836no-tls-tickets
13837 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13838 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13839 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013840 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13841 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013842 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13843 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13844 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013845 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013846
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013847no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013848 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013849 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13850 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013851 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13852 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013853 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013854
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013855 Supported in default-server: No
13856
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013857no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013858 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013859 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13860 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013861 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13862 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013863 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013864
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013865 Supported in default-server: No
13866
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013867no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013868 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013869 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13870 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013871 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13872 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013873 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013874
13875 Supported in default-server: No
13876
13877no-tlsv13
13878 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13879 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13880 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13881 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13882 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013883 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013884
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013885 Supported in default-server: No
13886
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013887no-verifyhost
13888 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13889 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13890 default value.
13891 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13892 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013893
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013894no-tfo
13895 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13896 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13897 default value.
13898 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13899 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13900
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013901non-stick
13902 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13903 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13904 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13905
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013906npn <protocols>
13907 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13908 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13909 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013910 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013911 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13912 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13913 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13914
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013915observe <mode>
13916 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13917 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13918 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13919 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13920 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13921 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013922 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013923
13924 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13925
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013926on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013927 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13928 Currently, four modes are available:
13929 - fastinter: force fastinter
13930 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13931 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13932 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13933 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13934
13935 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13936
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013937on-marked-down <action>
13938 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13939 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013940 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13941 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13942 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13943 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13944 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13945 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13946 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13947 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013948
13949 Actions are disabled by default
13950
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013951on-marked-up <action>
13952 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13953 Currently one action is available:
13954 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13955 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13956 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13957 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013958 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13959 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013960 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13961 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13962
13963 Actions are disabled by default
13964
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013965pool-low-conn <max>
13966 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13967 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13968 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13969 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13970 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13971 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13972 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13973 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13974 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13975 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13976 applying to "http-reuse".
13977
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013978pool-max-conn <max>
13979 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13980 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13981 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13982 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13983 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13984 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13985
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013986pool-purge-delay <delay>
13987 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013988 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013989 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013990
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013991port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013992 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13993 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13994 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13995 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13996 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13997 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13998
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013999proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014000 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14001 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14002 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
14003 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014004 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014005 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014007redir <prefix>
14008 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14009 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14010 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14011 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14012 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14013 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14014 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14015 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014016 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014017 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014018 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14019 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14020 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14021 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14022
14023 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14024
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014025rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014026 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14027 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14028 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14029
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014030resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14031 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14032 server.
14033
14034 Available options:
14035
14036 * allow-dup-ip
14037 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14038 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14039 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14040 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14041 For such case, simply enable this option.
14042 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14043
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014044 * ignore-weight
14045 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14046 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14047 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14048
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014049 * prevent-dup-ip
14050 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14051 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14052 same fqdn.
14053 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14054
14055 Example:
14056 backend b_myapp
14057 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14058 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14059 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14060
14061 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14062 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14063 it
14064 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14065 different address
14066
14067 Default value: not set
14068
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014069resolve-prefer <family>
14070 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14071 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14072 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14073 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14074
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014075 Default value: ipv6
14076
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014077 Example:
14078
14079 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014080
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014081resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014082 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014083 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014084 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014085 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14086 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014087 configured network, another address is selected.
14088
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014089 Example:
14090
14091 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014092
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014093resolvers <id>
14094 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14095 hostname.
14096
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014097 Example:
14098
14099 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014100
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014101 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014102
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014103send-proxy
14104 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14105 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14106 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14107 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014108 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14109 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14110 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14111 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14112 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14113 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14114 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14115 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14116 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14117 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014118 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14119 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014120
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014121send-proxy-v2
14122 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14123 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14124 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14125 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014126 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14127 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14128 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14129 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014130
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014131proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014132 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14133 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14134
14135 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14136 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14137 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14138 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14139 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14140 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14141 connection is supported).
14142 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14143 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14144 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14145 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14146 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14147 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14148 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014149
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014150send-proxy-v2-ssl
14151 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14152 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14153 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14154 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14155 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14156 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14157 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014158 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14159 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014160
14161send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14162 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14163 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14164 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14165 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14166 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14167 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14168 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14169 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014170 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14171 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014172
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014173slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014174 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14175 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14176 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14177 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14178 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14179 parameters :
14180
14181 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14182 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14183
14184 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14185 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14186 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14187 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14188
14189 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14190 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14191 seen as failed.
14192
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014193sni <expression>
14194 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14195 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14196 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14197 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014198 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14199 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014200 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014201 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14202 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014203
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014204source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014205source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014206source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014207 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14208 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14209 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14210 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14211
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014212 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14213 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14214 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14215 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14216 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14217 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14218 server.
14219
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014220 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14221 specifying the source address without port(s).
14222
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014223ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014224 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14225 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14226 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14227 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14228 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14229 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014230 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14231 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014232
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014233ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14234 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14235 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14236 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14237
14238ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14239 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14240 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14241 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14242
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014243ssl-reuse
14244 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14245 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14246 default value.
14247 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14248 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14249
14250stick
14251 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14252 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14253 default value.
14254 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14255 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014256
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014257socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014258 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014259 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14260 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14261
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014262tcp-ut <delay>
14263 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14264 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14265 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014266 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014267 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14268 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14269 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14270 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14271 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14272 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14273 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14274 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14275 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14276
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014277tfo
14278 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14279 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14280 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14281 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14282 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014283 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014285track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014286 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14287 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14288 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14289 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014290 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14291
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014292tls-tickets
14293 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14294 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14295 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014296 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14297 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14298 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014299 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014300 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014301
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014302verify [none|required]
14303 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014304 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014305 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14306 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014307 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014308 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14309 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14310 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14311 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14312 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14313 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14314 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14315 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014316
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014317verifyhost <hostname>
14318 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014319 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14320 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14321 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14322 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14323 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14324 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14325 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14326 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014327
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014328weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014329 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14330 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14331 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014332 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14333 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14334 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14335 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14336 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14337 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014338
14339
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143405.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14341-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014342
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014343HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14344using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombsdab4ba62021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014345configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014346This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14347can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14348workload.
14349This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14350resolution at run time.
14351Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14352carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14353
14354
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143555.3.1. Global overview
14356----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014357
14358As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14359different steps of the process life:
14360
14361 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14362 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14363 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14364
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014365 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14366 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014367
14368A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14369 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14370 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14371 resolution to know this new IP.
14372
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014373When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014374HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014375SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14376from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14377will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14378will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014379
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014380A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014381 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014382 first valid response.
14383
14384 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14385 servers return an error.
14386
14387
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143885.3.2. The resolvers section
14389----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014390
14391This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014392HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14393contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014394
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014395When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14396uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14397is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14398answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14399
14400When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014401used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014402
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014403 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14404 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14405 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014406
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014407 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14408 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014409
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014410 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14411 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14412 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014413
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014414For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14415following scenarios are possible:
14416
14417 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14418 ignored
14419
14420 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14421 applied
14422
14423 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14424 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14425
14426 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14427 retries the query with a new type
14428
14429 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14430 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014431
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014432As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14433a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014434<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014435
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014436
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014437resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014438 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014439
14440A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14441
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014442accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014443 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014444 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014445 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14446 by RFC 6891)
14447
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014448 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14449
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014450nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14451 DNS server description:
14452 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14453 <ip> : IP address of the server
14454 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14455
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014456parse-resolv-conf
14457 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14458 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14459 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14460
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014461hold <status> <period>
14462 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14463 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014464 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014465 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014466 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14467 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14468 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14469
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014470 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014471
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014472resolve_retries <nb>
14473 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14474 giving up.
14475 Default value: 3
14476
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014477 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14478 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14479 type.
14480
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014481timeout <event> <time>
14482 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14483 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14484 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014485 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14486 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014487 Default value: 1s
14488 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014489 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014490 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014491 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14492 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14493
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014494 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014495
14496 resolvers mydns
14497 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14498 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014499 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014500 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014501 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014502 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014503 hold other 30s
14504 hold refused 30s
14505 hold nx 30s
14506 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014507 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014508 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014509
14510
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200145116. Cache
14512---------
14513
14514HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14515(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14516RAM.
14517
14518The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14519this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14520
14521If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14522independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14523when we try to allocate a new one.
14524
14525The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14526
14527It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14528"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14529for more details.
14530
14531When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14532replaced by "<CACHE>".
14533
14534
145356.1. Limitation
14536----------------
14537
14538The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14539
14540- If the response is not a 200
14541- If the response contains a Vary header
14542- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14543- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonea8e0812020-11-26 15:51:29 +010014544- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
14545 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
14546 headers)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014547
14548- If the request is not a GET
14549- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14550- If the request contains an Authorization header
14551
14552
145536.2. Setup
14554-----------
14555
14556To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14557the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14558
14559
145606.2.1. Cache section
14561---------------------
14562
14563cache <name>
14564 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14565 size of cache is mandatory.
14566
14567total-max-size <megabytes>
14568 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14569 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14570
14571max-object-size <bytes>
14572 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14573 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14574 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14575
14576max-age <seconds>
14577 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14578 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14579 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14580 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14581 default.
14582
14583
145846.2.2. Proxy section
14585---------------------
14586
14587http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14588 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14589 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14590 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14591 after this one.
14592
14593http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14594 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14595 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14596 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14597 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14598
14599
14600Example:
14601
14602 backend bck1
14603 mode http
14604
14605 http-request cache-use foobar
14606 http-response cache-store foobar
14607 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14608
14609 cache foobar
14610 total-max-size 4
14611 max-age 240
14612
14613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146147. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14615----------------------------------
14616
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014617HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014618client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14619The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14620these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14621but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14622data called patterns.
14623
14624
146257.1. ACL basics
14626---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014627
14628The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14629content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14630from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14631simple :
14632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014633 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014634 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014635 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14636 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014638The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14639adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014640
14641In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014643 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014644
14645This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14646Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14647and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014648an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14649conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14650as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14651are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014652
14653ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14654'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14655which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14656
14657There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14658performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014660The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14661specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14662this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014663methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14664ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014665
14666Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14667 - boolean
14668 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14669 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14670 - string
14671 - data block
14672
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014673Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14674converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14675would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14676The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14677which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14678
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014679Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14680keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14681fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14682which are summarized in the table below :
14683
14684 +---------------------+-----------------+
14685 | Sample or converter | Default |
14686 | output type | matching method |
14687 +---------------------+-----------------+
14688 | boolean | bool |
14689 +---------------------+-----------------+
14690 | integer | int |
14691 +---------------------+-----------------+
14692 | ip | ip |
14693 +---------------------+-----------------+
14694 | string | str |
14695 +---------------------+-----------------+
14696 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14697 +---------------------+-----------------+
14698
14699Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14700matching method, see below.
14701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014702The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14703 - boolean
14704 - integer or integer range
14705 - IP address / network
14706 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14707 - regular expression
14708 - hex block
14709
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014710The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14711
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014712 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14713 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014714 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014715 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014716 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014717 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014718 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014720The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14721read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14722if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14723lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14724will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14725beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14726a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14727lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14728exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14729
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014730The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14731parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14732ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14733a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14734check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14735
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014736The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14737socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14738file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014740Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14741loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14742
14743 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14744
14745In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14746the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14747case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14748as well.
14749
14750The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14751sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14752do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14753methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14754is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014755obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014756followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14757default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14758that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14759string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14760
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014761The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14762By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14763string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14764resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14765server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014766waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014767flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14768function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014770There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14771sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14772be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014773
14774 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14775 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014776 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14777 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14778 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14779 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014780
14781 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14782 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014783 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014784
14785 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014786 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014787
14788 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014789 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014790
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014791 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014792 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14793
14794 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14795 binary or string samples.
14796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014797 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14798 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014800 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14801 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14802 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014804 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14805 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014807 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14808 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014810 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14811 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014813 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14814 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014815 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014817 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14818 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14819 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014820
14821For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14822request, it is possible to do :
14823
14824 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14825
14826In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14827buffer, one would use the following acl :
14828
14829 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14830
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014831On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14832possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14833
14834 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014836All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14837criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14838method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14839to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14840criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14841the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014843If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014844the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14845For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014847 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14848 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14849 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14850 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014851
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014852
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014853The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14854types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14855combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14856brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14857default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014859 +-------------------------------------------------+
14860 | Input sample type |
14861 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014862 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014863 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14864 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14865 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014866 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014867 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014868 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014869 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014870 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014871 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014872 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014873 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014874 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014875 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014876 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014877 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014878 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014879 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014880 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014881 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014882 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014883 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014884 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014885 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014886 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014887 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14888 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14889 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014890
14891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200148927.1.1. Matching booleans
14893------------------------
14894
14895In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14896Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14897When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14898that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14899
14900Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14901return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14902"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14903
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149057.1.2. Matching integers
14906------------------------
14907
14908Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14909enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14910to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14911
14912Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14913matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14914lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014915
14916For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14917unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14918representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14919
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014920As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14921two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14922instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14923ranges and operators.
14924
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014925For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014926operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14927Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14928of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014929
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014930Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014931
14932 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14933 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14934 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14935 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14936 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14937
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014938For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014939
14940 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14941
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014942This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14943
14944 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14945
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149477.1.3. Matching strings
14948-----------------------
14949
14950String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14951different forms :
14952
14953 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014954 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014955
14956 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014957 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014958
14959 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14960 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14961
14962 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14963 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14964
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014965 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014966 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14967 matches.
14968
14969 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14970 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14971 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014972
14973String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14974exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14975characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14976string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14977to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014978before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014979
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014980Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14981(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14982Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14983
14984Example:
14985 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14986 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14987
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149897.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14990---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014991
14992Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14993they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14994possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14995passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14996the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014997the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14998match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014999
15000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150017.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15002-------------------------------------
15003
15004It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15005not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15006a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15007to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15008digits may be used upper or lower case.
15009
15010Example :
15011 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15012 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15013
15014
150157.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15016---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015017
15018IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15019netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15020within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015021host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015022difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15023at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15024does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15025parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015026
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015027The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15028abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15029
15030 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15031 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15032 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15033 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15034 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15035 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15036 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15037 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15038
15039Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15040192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15041
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015042IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15043Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15044trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15045IPv6 patterns.
15046
15047HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15048following situations :
15049 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15050 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15051 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15052 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15053 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15054 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15055 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15056 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15057 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15058 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015060
150617.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15062----------------------------------
15063
15064Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15065combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15066
15067 - AND (implicit)
15068 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15069 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015071A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015073 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015075Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15076indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015078For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15079"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15080requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15081is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15082
15083 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015084 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15085 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15086 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015087
15088To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15089and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15090
15091 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15092 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15093 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15094 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15095
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015096 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015097 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15098 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15099 use_backend www if host_www
15100
15101It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15102expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15103be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15104the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15105
15106 The following rule :
15107
15108 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015109 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015110
15111 Can also be written that way :
15112
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015113 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015114
15115It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15116to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15117simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15118sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15119good use is the following :
15120
15121 With named ACLs :
15122
15123 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15124 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15125 monitor fail if site_dead
15126
15127 With anonymous ACLs :
15128
15129 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15130
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015131See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15132keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015133
15134
151357.3. Fetching samples
15136---------------------
15137
15138Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15139against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15140sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15141ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15142of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15143available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15144
15145This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15146Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15147compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15148deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15149
15150The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15151matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15152method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15153indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15154
15155As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15156when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15157mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15158the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15159ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15160
15161Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15162multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15163when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015164incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15165are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015166is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15167all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15168
15169Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15170 - name
15171 - name(arg1)
15172 - name(arg1,arg2)
15173
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015174
151757.3.1. Converters
15176-----------------
15177
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015178Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15179of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15180is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15181was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015182has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015183unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15184
15185These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15186sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15187the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015188support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015189
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015190A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15191support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15192supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15193(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15194bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015196The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015197
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001519851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15199 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15200 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15201 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15202 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15203 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15204
15205 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015206 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15207 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015208 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15209 frontend http-in
15210 bind *:8081
15211 default_backend servers
15212 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15213 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15214
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015215add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015216 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015217 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015218 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15219 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015220 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015221 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15222 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15223 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15224 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015225 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015226 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015227
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015228aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15229 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15230 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15231 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15232 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15233 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15234 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15235
15236 Example:
15237 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15238 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15239
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015240and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015241 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015242 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015243 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15244 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015245 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015246 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15247 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15248 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15249 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015250 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015251 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015252
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015253b64dec
15254 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15255 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
15256
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015257base64
15258 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015259 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015260 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
15261
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015262bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015263 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015264 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015265 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015266 presence of a flag).
15267
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015268bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15269 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15270 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015271 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015272
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015273concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15274 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15275 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15276 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15277 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15278 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15279 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15280 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15281 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15282 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15283 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015284 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015285 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015286 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15287 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015288
15289 Example:
15290 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15291 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15292 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015293 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015294 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15295
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015296cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015297 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15298 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015299
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015300crc32([<avalanche>])
15301 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15302 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15303 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15304 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15305 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15306 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15307 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15308 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15309 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15310 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015311 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15312
15313crc32c([<avalanche>])
15314 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15315 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15316 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15317 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15318 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15319 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15320 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15321 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015322
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015323cut_crlf
15324 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15325 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15326 updated.
15327
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015328da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015329 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15330 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15331 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15332 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015333 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015334 configuration language.
15335
15336 Example:
15337 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015338 bind *:8881
15339 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015340 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015341
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015342debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15343 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15344 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15345 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15346 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15347 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15348 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15349 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15350 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15351 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15352 printable sample types.
15353
15354 Example:
15355 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015356
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015357digest(<algorithm>)
15358 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15359 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15360
15361 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15362 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15363
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015364div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015365 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15366 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015367 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015368 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15369 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015370 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015371 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15372 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15373 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15374 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015375 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015376 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015377
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015378djb2([<avalanche>])
15379 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15380 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15381 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15382 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15383 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15384 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15385 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015386 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15387 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015388
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015389even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015390 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015391 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15392
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015393field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15394 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15395 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15396 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15397 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15398 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15399 fields.
15400
15401 Example :
15402 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15403 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15404 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15405 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15406 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015407
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015408hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015409 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015410 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015411 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015412 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015413
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015414hex2i
15415 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015416 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015417
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015418htonl
15419 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15420 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15421 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15422 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15423
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015424hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15425 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15426 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15427 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15428 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15429
15430 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15431 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15432
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015433http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015434 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15435 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015436 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15437 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15438 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15439 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15440 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15441 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15442 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15443 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015444
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015445iif(<true>,<false>)
15446 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15447 string otherwise.
15448
15449 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015450 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015451
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015452in_table(<table>)
15453 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15454 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15455 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015456 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015457 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15458
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015459ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15460 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015461 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015462 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15463 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15464 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15465 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15466 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015467
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015468json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015469 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015470 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015471 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015472 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15473 of errors:
15474 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15475 bytes, ...)
15476 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15477 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15478
15479 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15480 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15481 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15482 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15483 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15484 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015485 - "ascii" : never fails;
15486 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15487 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015488 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015489 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015490 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15491 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15492
15493 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015494 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015495
15496 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015497 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015498 capture request header user-agent len 150
15499 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015500
15501 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15502 GET / HTTP/1.0
15503 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15504
15505 Output log:
15506 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15507
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015508language(<value>[,<default>])
15509 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15510 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15511 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15512 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15513 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15514 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15515 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15516 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15517 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015518 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015519 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15520 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015521
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015522 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015523
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015524 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15525 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015526
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015527 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15528 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15529 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15530 use_backend spanish if es
15531 use_backend french if fr
15532 use_backend english if en
15533 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015534
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015535length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015536 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15537 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15538 type. The result is of type integer.
15539
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015540lower
15541 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15542 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15543 type. The result is of type string.
15544
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015545ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15546 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15547 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15548 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15549 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15550 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15551 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15552
15553 Example :
15554
15555 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015556 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015557 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15558
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015559ltrim(<chars>)
15560 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15561 representation of the input sample.
15562
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015563map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15564map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15565map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15566 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15567 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15568 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15569 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15570 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15571 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15572 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15573 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015574
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015575 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15576 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15577 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015578
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015579 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015580 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015581
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015582 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15583 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15584 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15585 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015586 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15587 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015588 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15589 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15590 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15591 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15592 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15593 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15594 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15595 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015596 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15597 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15598 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015599 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15600 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15601 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15602 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15603 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015604
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015605 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15606 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15607 the corresponding match text.
15608
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015609 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15610 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15611 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15612 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15613 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015614
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015615 Example :
15616
15617 # this is a comment and is ignored
15618 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15619 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15620 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15621 | | | `---------- value
15622 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15623 | `---------------------------- key
15624 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15625
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015626mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015627 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15628 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015629 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015630 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015631 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015632 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15633 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15634 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15635 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015636 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015637 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015638
15639mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015640 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015641 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15642 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015643 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015644 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015645 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015646 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15647 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15648 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15649 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015650 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015651 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015652
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015653nbsrv
15654 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15655 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15656 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15657 map lookup.
15658
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015659neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015660 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15661 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15662 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15663 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015664
15665not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015666 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015667 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015668 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015669 absence of a flag).
15670
15671odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015672 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015673 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15674
15675or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015676 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015677 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015678 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15679 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015680 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015681 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15682 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15683 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15684 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015685 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015686 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015687
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015688protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15689 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15690 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15691 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15692 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15693 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15694 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15695 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15696 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15697 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15698 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15699 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15700
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015701regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015702 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15703 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15704 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15705 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15706 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15707 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15708 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15709 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15710 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015711 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15712 of characters with other ones.
15713
15714 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15715 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15716 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15717 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15718 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15719 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015720
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015721 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015722
15723 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15724 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15725 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015726 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015727
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015728 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15729 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15730
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015731 # capture groups and backreferences
15732 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020015733 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015734 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15735
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015736capture-req(<id>)
15737 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15738 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15739
15740 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015741 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15742 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015743
15744capture-res(<id>)
15745 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15746 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15747
15748 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015749 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15750 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015751
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015752rtrim(<chars>)
15753 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15754 of the input sample.
15755
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015756sdbm([<avalanche>])
15757 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15758 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15759 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15760 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15761 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15762 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15763 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015764 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15765 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015766
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015767secure_memcmp(<var>)
15768 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15769 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15770 match.
15771
15772 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15773 performed in constant time.
15774
15775 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15776 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15777
15778 Example :
15779
15780 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15781 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15782 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15783 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15784
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015785set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015786 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15787 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15788 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015789 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015790 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15791 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015792 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015793 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15794 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015795 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015796 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015797
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015798sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015799 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015800 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15801
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015802sha2([<bits>])
15803 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15804 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15805
15806 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15807 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15808
15809 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15810 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15811
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015812srv_queue
15813 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15814 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15815 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15816 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15817 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15818
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015819strcmp(<var>)
15820 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15821 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15822 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15823 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15824 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15825 shorter).
15826
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015827 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15828 strings in constant time.
15829
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015830 Example :
15831
15832 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15833 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15834 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15835
15836
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015837sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015838 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15839 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015840 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015841 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15842 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015843 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015844 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15845 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015846 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015847 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15848 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015849 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015850 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015851
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015852table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15853 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15854 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15855 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15856 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15857 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15858 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15859
15860
15861table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15862 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15863 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15864 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15865 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15866 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15867 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15868
15869table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15870 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15871 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015872 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015873 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15874 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15875
15876table_conn_cur(<table>)
15877 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15878 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15879 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15880 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15881 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15882
15883table_conn_rate(<table>)
15884 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15885 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15886 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15887 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15888 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15889
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015890table_gpt0(<table>)
15891 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15892 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15893 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15894 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15895 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15896
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015897table_gpc0(<table>)
15898 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15899 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15900 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15901 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15902 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15903
15904table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15905 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15906 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15907 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15908 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15909 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15910 sample fetch keyword.
15911
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015912table_gpc1(<table>)
15913 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15914 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15915 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15916 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15917 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15918
15919table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15920 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15921 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15922 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15923 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15924 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15925 sample fetch keyword.
15926
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015927table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15928 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15929 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015930 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015931 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15932 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15933
15934table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15935 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15936 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15937 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15938 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15939 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15940 keyword.
15941
15942table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15943 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15944 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015945 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015946 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15947 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15948
15949table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15950 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15951 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15952 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15953 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15954 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15955 keyword.
15956
15957table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15958 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15959 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015960 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015961 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15962 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15963 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15964 keyword.
15965
15966table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15967 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15968 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015969 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015970 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15971 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15972 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15973 keyword.
15974
15975table_server_id(<table>)
15976 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15977 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15978 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15979 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15980 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15981 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15982
15983table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15984 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15985 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015986 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015987 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15988 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15989 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15990 keyword.
15991
15992table_sess_rate(<table>)
15993 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15994 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15995 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15996 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15997 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15998 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15999 keyword.
16000
16001table_trackers(<table>)
16002 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16003 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16004 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16005 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16006 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16007 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16008 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16009 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16010 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16011 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16012
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016013upper
16014 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16015 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16016 type. The result is of type string.
16017
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016018url_dec([<in_form>])
16019 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16020 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16021 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16022 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16023 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16024 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016025
William Dauchy55ed7c42021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016026url_enc([<enc_type>])
16027 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16028 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16029 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16030 optional argument is here for future changes.
16031
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016032ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016033 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016034 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16035 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16036 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016037 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16038 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16039 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16040 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016041 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016042 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16043 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016044
16045 Example:
16046 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16047 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16048
16049 message Point {
16050 int32 latitude = 1;
16051 int32 longitude = 2;
16052 }
16053
16054 message PPoint {
16055 Point point = 59;
16056 }
16057
16058 message Rectangle {
16059 // One corner of the rectangle.
16060 PPoint lo = 48;
16061 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16062 PPoint hi = 49;
16063 }
16064
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016065 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16066 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16067 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016068
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016069 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16070 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016071 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016072 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16073
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016074 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016075
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016076 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016077
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016078 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16079 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16080 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016081
16082 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16083 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16084 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16085
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016086 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16087 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16088 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016089
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016090
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016091unset-var(<var name>)
16092 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16093 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16094 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16095 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16096 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16097 response),
16098 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16099 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16100 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16101 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16102
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016103utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16104 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16105 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16106 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16107 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16108 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16109 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16110
16111 Example :
16112
16113 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016114 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016115 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16116
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016117word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16118 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16119 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16120 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016121 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016122 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16123 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16124
16125 Example :
16126 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16127 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16128 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16129 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16130 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016131 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016132
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016133wt6([<avalanche>])
16134 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16135 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16136 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16137 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16138 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16139 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16140 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016141 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16142 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016143
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016144xor(<value>)
16145 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016146 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016147 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016148 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016149 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016150 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16151 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016152 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016153 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16154 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016155 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016156 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016157
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016158xxh32([<seed>])
16159 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16160 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16161 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16162 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16163 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16164 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16165 as cryptographically secure.
16166
16167xxh64([<seed>])
16168 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16169 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16170 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16171 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16172 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16173 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16174 as cryptographically secure.
16175
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016176
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161777.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016178--------------------------------------------
16179
16180A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16181not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16182"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16183The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16184
16185always_false : boolean
16186 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16187 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16188
16189always_true : boolean
16190 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16191 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16192
16193avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016194 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016195 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16196 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16197 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16198 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16199 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16200 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16201 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16202 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16203 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16204 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16205 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16206 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16207 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016209be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016210 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16211 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16212 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16213 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016214 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16215
16216be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16217 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16218 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16219 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16220 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16221 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016222 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16223 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016224
16225 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16226 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16227 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016229be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16230 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16231 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16232 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016233 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016234 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16235 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016236
16237 Example :
16238 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16239 backend dynamic
16240 mode http
16241 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16242 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016243
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016244bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016245 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16246 of the string.
16247
16248bool(<bool>) : bool
16249 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16250 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016252connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16253 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016254 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016255 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16256 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016257
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016258 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016259 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016260 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16261
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016262 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16263 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016264
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016265 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016266 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016267 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016268 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016269 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016270 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016271 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016272
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016273 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16274 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016275 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016276 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016277
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016278cpu_calls : integer
16279 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16280 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16281 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16282 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16283 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16284 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16285
16286cpu_ns_avg : integer
16287 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16288 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16289 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16290 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16291 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16292 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16293 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16294 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16295 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16296 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16297 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16298
16299cpu_ns_tot : integer
16300 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16301 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16302 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16303 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16304 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16305 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16306 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16307 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16308 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16309 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16310 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16311 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16312 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16313
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016314date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016315 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016316
16317 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16318 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16319 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016320 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16321
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016322 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16323 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16324 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16325 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16326 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16327
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016328 Example :
16329
16330 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16331 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016332
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016333 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16334 # millisecond granularity
16335 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16336
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016337date_us : integer
16338 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16339 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16340 from the same timeval structure.
16341
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016342distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16343 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16344 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16345 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16346 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16347 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16348 list of supported tokens.
16349
16350distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16351 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16352 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16353 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16354 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16355 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16356 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16357 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16358 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16359 supported tokens.
16360
16361 Example :
16362 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16363 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16364 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16365 # send large files to the big farm
16366 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16367
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016368env(<name>) : string
16369 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16370 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16371 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16372 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16373 certain way.
16374
16375 Examples :
16376 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16377 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16378
16379 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16380 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016382fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16383 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016384 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16385 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016386 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16387 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016388 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016389 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16390 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016391
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016392fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16393 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16394 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16395 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016397fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16398 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16399 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16400 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16401 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16402 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16403 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16404 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16405 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016406
16407 Example :
16408 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16409 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16410 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16411 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16412 frontend mail
16413 bind :25
16414 mode tcp
16415 maxconn 100
16416 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16417 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16418 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16419 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016420
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016421hostname : string
16422 Returns the system hostname.
16423
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016424int(<integer>) : signed integer
16425 Returns a signed integer.
16426
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016427ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16428 Returns an ipv4.
16429
16430ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16431 Returns an ipv6.
16432
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016433lat_ns_avg : integer
16434 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16435 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16436 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16437 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16438 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16439 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16440 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16441 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16442 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016443 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16444 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16445 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16446 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16447 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16448 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016449
16450lat_ns_tot : integer
16451 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16452 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16453 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16454 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16455 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16456 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16457 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16458 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16459 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016460 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16461 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16462 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16463 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16464 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016465 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16466 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16467 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16468 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16469 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16470 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16471
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016472meth(<method>) : method
16473 Returns a method.
16474
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016475nbproc : integer
16476 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16477 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16478 and debugging purposes.
16479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016480nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16481 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16482 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16483 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016484 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16485 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16486 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016487
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016488prio_class : integer
16489 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16490 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16491 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16492
16493prio_offset : integer
16494 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16495 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16496 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16497 set-priority-offset".
16498
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016499proc : integer
16500 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16501 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16502 debugging purposes.
16503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016504queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016505 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16506 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16507 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016508 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16509 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16510 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16511 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16512 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16513
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016514rand([<range>]) : integer
16515 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16516 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16517 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16518 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16519 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16520
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016521uuid([<version>]) : string
16522 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16523 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16524 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016526srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16527 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16528 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16529 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16530 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16531 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016532 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16533 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16534
16535srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16536 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16537 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16538 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16539 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16540 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16541 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16542 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16543
16544 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16545 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016546
16547srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16548 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16549 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16550 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016551 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016552 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16553 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16554 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16555
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016556srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16557 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16558 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16559 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16560 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16561 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16562 fetch methods.
16563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016564srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16565 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16566 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016567 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016568 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16569 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016570 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016571 overloading servers).
16572
16573 Example :
16574 # Redirect to a separate back
16575 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16576 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16577 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16578
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016579srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16580 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16581 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16582 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16583
16584srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16585 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16586 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16587 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16588
16589srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16590 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16591 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16592 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16593
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016594stopping : boolean
16595 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16596 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16597 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16598
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016599str(<string>) : string
16600 Returns a string.
16601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016602table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16603 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16604 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16605
16606table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16607 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16608 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16609 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16610
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016611thread : integer
16612 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16613 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16614 and debugging purposes.
16615
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016616var(<var-name>) : undefined
16617 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016618 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16619 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016620 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016621 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16622 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016623 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016624 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16625 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016626 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016627 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016628
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200166297.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016630----------------------------------
16631
16632The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16633closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16634methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16635sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16636TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016637the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16638counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016639"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16640used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16641can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16642Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16643table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16644tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16645currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016646
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016647bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016648 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16649 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16650 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016652be_id : integer
16653 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016654 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16655 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016656
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016657be_name : string
16658 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016659 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16660 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016662dst : ip
16663 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16664 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16665 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16666 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016667 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16668 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16669 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16670 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16671 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16672 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016673
16674dst_conn : integer
16675 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16676 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16677 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16678 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16679 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16680 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16681 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16682 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016683
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016684dst_is_local : boolean
16685 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16686 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16687 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16688 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016689 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016690 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16691 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16692 it only once per connection.
16693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016694dst_port : integer
16695 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16696 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16697 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16698 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16699 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16700 an HTTP header.
16701
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016702fc_http_major : integer
16703 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16704 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16705 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16706
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016707fc_pp_authority : string
16708 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16709 if any.
16710
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016711fc_pp_unique_id : string
16712 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16713 if any.
16714
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016715fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16716 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16717 header.
16718
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016719fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16720 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16721 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16722 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16723 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16724 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16725 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16726
16727fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16728 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16729 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16730 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16731 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16732 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16733 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16734
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016735fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016736 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16737 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16738 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16739 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16740
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016741fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016742 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16743 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16744 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16745 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16746
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016747fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016748 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16749 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16750 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16751 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16752
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016753fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016754 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16755 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16756 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16757 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16758
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016759fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016760 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16761 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16762 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16763 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16764
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016765fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016766 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16767 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16768 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16769 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16770
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016771fe_defbe : string
16772 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16773 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016775fe_id : integer
16776 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016777 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016778 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16779
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016780fe_name : string
16781 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16782 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16783 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16784
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016785sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016786sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16787sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16788sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016789 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16790 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16791 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16792
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016793sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016794sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16795sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16796sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016797 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16798 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16799 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16800
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016801sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016802sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16803sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16804sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016805 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16806 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016807 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16808 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16809 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016810
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016811 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016812 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16813 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016814 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16815 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16816 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016817 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16818 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16819
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016820sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16821sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16822sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16823sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16824 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16825 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16826 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16827 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16828 when a first ACL was verified.
16829
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016830sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016831sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16832sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16833sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016834 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016835 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16836
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016837sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016838sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16839sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16840sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016841 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16842 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16843 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16844
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016845sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016846sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16847sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16848sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016849 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16850 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16851 See also src_conn_rate.
16852
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016853sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016854sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16855sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16856sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016857 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016858 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016859
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016860sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16861sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16862sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16863sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16864 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16865 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16866
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016867sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16868sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16869sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16870sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16871 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16872 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16873
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016874sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016875sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16876sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16877sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016878 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16879 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16880 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016881 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16882 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16883 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016884
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016885sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16886sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16887sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16888sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16889 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16890 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16891 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16892 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16893 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16894 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16895
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016896sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016897sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16898sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16899sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016900 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016901 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16902 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16903
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016904sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016905sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16906sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16907sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016908 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16909 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16910 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16911 src_http_err_rate.
16912
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016913sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016914sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16915sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16916sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016917 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016918 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16919 src_http_req_cnt.
16920
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016921sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016922sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16923sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16924sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016925 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16926 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16927 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16928 src_http_req_rate.
16929
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016930sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016931sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16932sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16933sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016934 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016935 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16936 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16937 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16938 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016939
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016940 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016941 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16942 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016943 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16944
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016945sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16946sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16947sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16948sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16949 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16950 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16951 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16952 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16953 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16954
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016955sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016956sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16957sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16958sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016959 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16960 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16961 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016962
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016963sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016964sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16965sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16966sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016967 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16968 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16969 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016970
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016971sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016972sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16973sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16974sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016975 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016976 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16977 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16978 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016979 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016980 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16981
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016982sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016983sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16984sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16985sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016986 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16987 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16988 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16989 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16990 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016991 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016992
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016993sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016994sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16995sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16996sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016997 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16998 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16999 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17000
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017001sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017002sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17003sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17004sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017005 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17006 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017007 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017008 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17009 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017010 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17011 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17012 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017014so_id : integer
17015 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17016 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17017 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017018
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017019so_name : string
17020 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17021 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17022 strings instead of integers.
17023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017024src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017025 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017026 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17027 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17028 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017029 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17030 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17031 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017032 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17033 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17034 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17035 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17036 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17037 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17038 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017039
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017040 Example:
17041 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17042 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017044src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17045 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17046 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17047 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017048 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017050src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17051 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17052 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017053 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017054 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017056src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17057 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17058 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17059 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17060 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17061 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17062 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017063
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017064 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017065 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17066 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17067 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17068 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017069 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017070 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17071 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17072
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017073src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17074 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17075 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17076 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17077 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17078 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17079 was verified.
17080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017081src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017082 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017083 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017084 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017085 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017087src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017088 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017089 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17090 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017091 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017093src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17094 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17095 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17096 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017097 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017099src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017100 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017101 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017102 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017103 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017104
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017105src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17106 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17107 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17108 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17109 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17110
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017111src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17112 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17113 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17114 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17115 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017117src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017118 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017119 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017120 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17121 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017122 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17123 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17124 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017125
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017126src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17127 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17128 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17129 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17130 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17131 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17132 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17133 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017135src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017136 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017137 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017138 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017139 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017140 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017142src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17143 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17144 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17145 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17146 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017147 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017149src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017150 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017151 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17152 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017153 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017155src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17156 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17157 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17158 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017159 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017160 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017162src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17163 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17164 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17165 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017166 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017167 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17168 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017169
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017170 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017171 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017172 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017173 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017174
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017175src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17176 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17177 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17178 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17179 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17180 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17181 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17182
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017183src_is_local : boolean
17184 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17185 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17186 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17187 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017188 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017189 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17190 once per connection.
17191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017192src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017193 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17194 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17195 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17196 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17197 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017199src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017200 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17201 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17202 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17203 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17204 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017206src_port : integer
17207 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17208 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17209 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17210 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017212src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017213 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017214 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17215 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17216 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017217 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017219src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17220 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17221 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17222 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17223 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017224 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017226src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17227 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17228 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17229 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17230 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17231 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17232 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17233 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17234 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017235
17236 Example :
17237 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17238 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17239 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17240 listen ssh
17241 bind :22
17242 mode tcp
17243 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017244 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017245 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017246 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017248srv_id : integer
17249 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17250 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017251 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017252
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017253srv_name : string
17254 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
17255 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017256 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017257
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172587.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017259----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020017260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017261The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
17262closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
17263when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
17264usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017265future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017266
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001726751d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
17268 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17269 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17270 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
17271 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17272 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17273
17274 Example :
17275 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17276 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17277 # the request.
17278 frontend http-in
17279 bind *:8081
17280 default_backend servers
17281 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17282 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17283
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017284ssl_bc : boolean
17285 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17286 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017287 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17288 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017289
17290ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17291 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017292 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17293 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017294
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017295ssl_bc_alpn : string
17296 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17297 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017298 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017299 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17300 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17301 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17302 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17303 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017304 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17305 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017306
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017307ssl_bc_cipher : string
17308 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017309 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17310 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017311
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017312ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17313 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17314 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17315 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017316 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017317
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017318ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17319 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17320 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017321 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17322 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017323
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017324ssl_bc_npn : string
17325 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17326 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017327 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017328 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17329 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17330 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17331 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017332 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17333 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017334
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017335ssl_bc_protocol : string
17336 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017337 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17338 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017339
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017340ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017341 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017342 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017343 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17344 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017345
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017346ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17347 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17348 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17349 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017350 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017351
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017352ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17353 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17354 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017355 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17356 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017357
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017358ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17359 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17360 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17361 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017362 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017363
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017364ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17365 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017366 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17367 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017369ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17370 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17371 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17372 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17373 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17374 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017376ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17377 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17378 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17379 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17380 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017381
Christopher Faulet7a507632020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017382ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017383 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17384 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17385 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17386 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17387 does not support resumed sessions.
17388
Christopher Faulet7a507632020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017389ssl_c_der : binary
17390 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17391 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17392 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017394ssl_c_err : integer
17395 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17396 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17397 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17398 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17399 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017400
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017401ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017402 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17403 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17404 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17405 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17406 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17407 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17408 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17409 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017410 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17411 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17412 LDAP v3.
17413 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17414 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017416ssl_c_key_alg : string
17417 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17418 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17419 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017421ssl_c_notafter : string
17422 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17423 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17424 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017426ssl_c_notbefore : string
17427 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17428 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17429 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017430
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017431ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017432 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17433 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17434 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17435 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17436 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17437 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17438 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17439 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017440 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17441 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17442 LDAP v3.
17443 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17444 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017446ssl_c_serial : binary
17447 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17448 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17449 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017451ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17452 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17453 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17454 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017455 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17456 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17457
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017458 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017459 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017461ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17462 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17463 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17464 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017466ssl_c_used : boolean
17467 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17468 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017470ssl_c_verify : integer
17471 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17472 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17473 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17474 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017476ssl_c_version : integer
17477 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17478 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017479
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017480ssl_f_der : binary
17481 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17482 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17483 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17484
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017485ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017486 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17487 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17488 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17489 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017490 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017491 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17492 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17493 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017494 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17495 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17496 LDAP v3.
17497 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17498 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017500ssl_f_key_alg : string
17501 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17502 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17503 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017505ssl_f_notafter : string
17506 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17507 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17508 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017510ssl_f_notbefore : string
17511 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17512 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17513 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017514
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017515ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017516 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17517 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17518 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17519 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17520 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17521 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17522 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17523 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017524 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17525 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17526 LDAP v3.
17527 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17528 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017530ssl_f_serial : binary
17531 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17532 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17533 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017534
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017535ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17536 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17537 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17538 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017540ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17541 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17542 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17543 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017545ssl_f_version : integer
17546 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17547 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17548
17549ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017550 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17551 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17552 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017554 Example :
17555 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17556 listen http-https
17557 bind :80
17558 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17559 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17560
17561ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17562 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17563 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17564
17565ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017566 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017567 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17568 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17569 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17570 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17571 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17572 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17573 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17574 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017576ssl_fc_cipher : string
17577 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17578 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017579
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017580ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17581 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17582 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017583 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017584
17585ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17586 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17587 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017588 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017589
17590ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17591 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17592 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17593 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017594 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017595 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017596
17597ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17598 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17599 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017600 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017601
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017602ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17603 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17604 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17605 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17606
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017607ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17608 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17609 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17610 transport layer.
17611 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17612 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17613 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17614 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17615
17616ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17617 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17618 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17619 transport layer.
17620 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17621 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17622 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17623 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17624
17625ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17626 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17627 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17628 transport layer.
17629 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17630 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17631 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17632 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17633
17634ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17635 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17636 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17637 transport layer.
17638 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17639 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17640 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17641 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17642
17643ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17644 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17645 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17646 transport layer.
17647 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17648 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17649 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17650 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017652ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017653 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17654 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017655 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17656 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17657 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17658 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017659
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017660ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17661 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17662 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17663 wait until the handshake happened.
17664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017665ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17666 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017667 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17668 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017669 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017670 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017671
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017672ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017673 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017674 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17675 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017677ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017678 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017679 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17680 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17681 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17682 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17683 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17684 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17685 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017687ssl_fc_protocol : string
17688 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17689 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017690
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017691ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017692 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017693 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17694 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017695
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017696ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17697 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17698 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17699 transport layer.
17700 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17701 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17702 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17703 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17704
17705ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17706 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17707 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17708 transport layer.
17709 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17710 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17711 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17712 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17713
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017714ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17715 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17716 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17717 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017719ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17720 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17721 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17722 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17723 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017724
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017725ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17726 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17727 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17728 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17729 BoringSSL.
17730
17731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017732ssl_fc_sni : string
17733 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17734 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17735 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17736 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17737 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17738
17739 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17740 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17741 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017742 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017743 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017745 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017746 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17747 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017749ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17750 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17751 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017752
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017753ssl_s_der : binary
17754 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17755 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17756 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17757
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017758ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17759 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17760 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17761 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17762 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17763 does not support resumed sessions.
17764
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017765ssl_s_key_alg : string
17766 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17767 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17768 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17769
17770ssl_s_notafter : string
17771 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17772 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17773 transport layer.
17774
17775ssl_s_notbefore : string
17776 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17777 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17778 transport layer.
17779
17780ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17781 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17782 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17783 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17784 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17785 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17786 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017787 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17788 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017789 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17790 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17791 LDAP v3.
17792 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17793 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17794
17795ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17796 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17797 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17798 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17799 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17800 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17801 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017802 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17803 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017804 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17805 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17806 LDAP v3.
17807 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17808 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17809
17810ssl_s_serial : binary
17811 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17812 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17813 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17814
17815ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17816 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17817 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17818 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17819
17820ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17821 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17822 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17823 layer.
17824
17825ssl_s_version : integer
17826 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17827 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017828
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200178297.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017830------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017832Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17833sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17834only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17835For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17836be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17837can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17838sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17839for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17840content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017842payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017843 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017844 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17845 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017847payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17848 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017849 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017850 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017852req.len : integer
17853req_len : integer (deprecated)
17854 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17855 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17856 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17857 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17858 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17859 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17860 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17861 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017863req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17864 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017865 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17866 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17867 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17868 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017870 ACL alternatives :
17871 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017873req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17874 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17875 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17876 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17877 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017879 ACL alternatives :
17880 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017882 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017884req.proto_http : boolean
17885req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17886 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17887 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17888 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17889 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17890 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17891 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17892 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017894 Example:
17895 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17896 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17897 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017898 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017900req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17901rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17902 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17903 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17904 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17905 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17906 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17907 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17908 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017910 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17911 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17912 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17913 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17914 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17915 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017917 ACL derivatives :
17918 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017920 Example :
17921 listen tse-farm
17922 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17923 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17924 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17925 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17926 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17927 persist rdp-cookie
17928 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17929 # This is only useful makes sense if
17930 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17931 stick-table type string size 204800
17932 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17933 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17934 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017936 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17937 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017939req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17940rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17941 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17942 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17943 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17944 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017946 ACL derivatives :
17947 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017948
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017949req.ssl_alpn : string
17950 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17951 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17952 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17953 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17954 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17955 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017956 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017957
17958 Examples :
17959 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17960 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17961 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017962 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017963 default_backend bk_default
17964
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017965req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17966 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17967 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017968 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17969 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17970 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17971 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17972 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017974req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17975req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17976 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17977 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17978 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17979 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17980 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17981 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17982 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017984req.ssl_sni : string
17985req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17986 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17987 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17988 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17989 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17990 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020017991 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
17992 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
17993 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
17994 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
17995 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
17996 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
17997 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
17998 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
17999 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018001 ACL derivatives :
18002 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018004 Examples :
18005 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18006 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18007 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18008 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18009 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018010
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018011req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18012 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18013 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18014 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18015 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18016 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18017 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18018 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18019 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18020 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018022req.ssl_ver : integer
18023req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18024 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18025 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18026 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18027 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18028 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18029 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18030 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018031 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018032 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018034 ACL derivatives :
18035 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018036
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018037res.len : integer
18038 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18039 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18040 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18041 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18042 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18043 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18044 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018045 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018047res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18048 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018049 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018050 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018051 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018052 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018054res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18055 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18056 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18057 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018058 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18059 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018061 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018062
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018063res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18064rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18065 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18066 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18067 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18068 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18069 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18070 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18071 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018073wait_end : boolean
18074 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18075 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018076 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018077 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18078 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018079 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018080 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18081 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018083 Examples :
18084 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18085 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18086 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018088 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18089 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18090 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18091 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18092 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18093 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18094 tcp-request content reject
18095
18096
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200180977.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018098--------------------------------------
18099
18100It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18101This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18102data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18103its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18104HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18105content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18106to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18107more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18108response are indexed.
18109
18110base : string
18111 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18112 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18113 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18114 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18115 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18116 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18117 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18118 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18119
18120 ACL derivatives :
18121 base : exact string match
18122 base_beg : prefix match
18123 base_dir : subdir match
18124 base_dom : domain match
18125 base_end : suffix match
18126 base_len : length match
18127 base_reg : regex match
18128 base_sub : substring match
18129
18130base32 : integer
18131 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18132 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18133 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018134 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18135 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18136 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018137
18138base32+src : binary
18139 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18140 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18141 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18142 per-URL counters.
18143
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018144capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18145 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18146 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18147 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18148
18149capture.req.method : string
18150 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18151 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18152 because it's allocated.
18153
18154capture.req.uri : string
18155 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18156 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18157 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18158 allocated.
18159
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018160capture.req.ver : string
18161 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18162 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18163 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18164
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018165capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18166 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18167 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18168 The first entry is an index of 0.
18169 See also: "capture response header"
18170
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018171capture.res.ver : string
18172 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18173 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18174 persistent flag.
18175
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018176req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018177 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18178 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18179 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018180
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018181req.body_param([<name>) : string
18182 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18183 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18184 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18185 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18186 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18187 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18188 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18189 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18190 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18191 given.
18192
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018193req.body_len : integer
18194 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18195 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018196 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18197 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018198
18199req.body_size : integer
18200 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018201 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18202 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018204req.cook([<name>]) : string
18205cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18206 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18207 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18208 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18209 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18210 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18211 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18212 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18213 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18214
18215 ACL derivatives :
18216 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18217 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18218 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18219 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18220 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18221 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18222 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18223 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018225req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18226cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18227 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18228 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018230req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18231cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18232 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18233 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
18234 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
18235 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018237cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18238 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18239 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
18240 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
18241 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018242 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018243 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
18244 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
18245 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
18246 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018248hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18249 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
18250 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
18251 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
18252 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018253 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018255req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
18256 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18257 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18258 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18259 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18260 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18261 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
18262 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
18263 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018265req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18266 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18267 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18268 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18269 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018271req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18272 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18273 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18274 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18275 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18276 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18277 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
18278 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
18279 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000018280 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018281 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018282 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018284 ACL derivatives :
18285 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18286 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18287 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18288 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18289 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18290 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18291 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18292 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18293
18294req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18295hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18296 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18297 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
18298 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
18299 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
18300 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
18301 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
18302 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
18303 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
18304 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
18305
18306req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18307hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18308 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18309 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18310 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
18311 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18312 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018313 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018314 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
18315 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
18316
18317req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18318hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18319 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18320 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18321 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
18322 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18323 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18324 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18325 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
18326
Christopher Faulet26167842020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018327req.hdrs : string
18328 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
18329 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18330 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18331 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
18332
18333req.hdrs_bin : binary
18334 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18335 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
18336 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
18337 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
18338 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
18339 names and values (length of 0 for both).
18340
18341 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018342
Christopher Faulet26167842020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018343 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18344 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018346http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18347 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18348 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18349 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18350 basic auth is supported.
18351
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018352http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18353 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18354 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18355 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18356 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018357 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18358 basic auth is supported.
18359
18360 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018361 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18362 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18363 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18364 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018365
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018366http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018367 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18368 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18369 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018370
18371http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018372 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18373 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18374 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018375
18376http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018377 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18378 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18379 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018381http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018382 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18383 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018384 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18385 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018387method : integer + string
18388 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18389 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18390 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18391 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18392 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18393 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18394 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018396 ACL derivatives :
18397 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018399 Example :
18400 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18401 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18402 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018404path : string
18405 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18406 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18407 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18408 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18409 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018410 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018411 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018413 ACL derivatives :
18414 path : exact string match
18415 path_beg : prefix match
18416 path_dir : subdir match
18417 path_dom : domain match
18418 path_end : suffix match
18419 path_len : length match
18420 path_reg : regex match
18421 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018422
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018423pathq : string
18424 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18425 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18426 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18427 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18428 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18429 result in both cases.
18430
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018431query : string
18432 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18433 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18434 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18435 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018436 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018437 which stops before the question mark.
18438
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018439req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18440 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18441 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18442 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18443 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018445req.ver : string
18446req_ver : string (deprecated)
18447 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18448 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18449 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018451 ACL derivatives :
18452 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018453
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018454res.body : binary
18455 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18456 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18457 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18458 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18459
18460res.body_len : integer
18461 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18462 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18463 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18464 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18465
18466res.body_size : integer
18467 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18468 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18469 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18470 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
18471 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
18472 based expect rules.
18473
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010018474res.cache_hit : boolean
18475 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
18476 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
18477
18478res.cache_name : string
18479 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
18480 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
18481 empty string.
18482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018483res.comp : boolean
18484 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18485 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18486 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018488res.comp_algo : string
18489 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18490 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18491 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018493res.cook([<name>]) : string
18494scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18495 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18496 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018497 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
18498 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018500 ACL derivatives :
18501 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018503res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18504scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18505 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18506 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018507 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
18508 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018510res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18511scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18512 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18513 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018514 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
18515 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018517res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18518 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18519 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18520 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18521 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18522 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
18523 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
18524 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
18525 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018526 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018528res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18529 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18530 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18531 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18532 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018533 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
18534 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018536res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18537shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
18538 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18539 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18540 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18541 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18542 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
18543 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
18544 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018545 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
18546 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018548 ACL derivatives :
18549 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18550 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18551 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18552 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18553 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18554 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18555 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18556 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18557
18558res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18559shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18560 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18561 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18562 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
18563 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018564 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018566res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18567shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18568 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
18569 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
18570 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
18571 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
18572 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018573 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
18574 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018575
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018576res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18577 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18578 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18579 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018580 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18581 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018583res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18584shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18585 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18586 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18587 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18588 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18589 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018590 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18591 based expect rules.
18592
18593res.hdrs : string
18594 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18595 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18596 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18597 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18598 based expect rules.
18599
18600res.hdrs_bin : binary
18601 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18602 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18603 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18604 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18605 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18606 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18607 (length of 0 for both).
18608
18609 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18610
18611 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18612 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018614res.ver : string
18615resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18616 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018617 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18618 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018620 ACL derivatives :
18621 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018623set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18624 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18625 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018626 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018627 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018629 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18630 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018632status : integer
18633 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18634 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018635 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18636 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018637
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018638unique-id : string
18639 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18640 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18641 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18642 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18643 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18644 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018646url : string
18647 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18648 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18649 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18650 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18651 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18652 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18653 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018655 ACL derivatives :
18656 url : exact string match
18657 url_beg : prefix match
18658 url_dir : subdir match
18659 url_dom : domain match
18660 url_end : suffix match
18661 url_len : length match
18662 url_reg : regex match
18663 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018665url_ip : ip
18666 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18667 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18668 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18669 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18670 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18671 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18672 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018674url_port : integer
18675 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18676 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18677 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18678 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018679
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018680urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18681url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018682 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18683 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018684 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18685 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18686 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18687 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018688 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18689 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018690 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18691 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018693 ACL derivatives :
18694 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18695 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18696 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18697 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18698 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18699 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18700 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18701 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018702
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018704 Example :
18705 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18706 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18707 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18708 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018709
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018710urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018711 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18712 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18713 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018714
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018715url32 : integer
18716 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18717 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18718 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18719 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18720 is an unsigned integer.
18721
18722url32+src : binary
18723 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18724 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18725 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18726
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018727
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200187287.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018729---------------------------------------
18730
18731This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18732used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18733purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18734There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18735or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18736any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18737for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18738
18739internal.htx.data : integer
18740 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18741 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18742
18743internal.htx.free : integer
18744 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18745 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18746
18747internal.htx.free_data : integer
18748 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18749 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18750
18751internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18752 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18753 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18754 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18755
18756internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18757 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18758 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18759
18760internal.htx.size : integer
18761 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18762 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18763
18764internal.htx.used : integer
18765 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18766 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18767 direction.
18768
18769internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18770 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18771 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18772 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18773 of the special value :
18774 * head : The oldest inserted block
18775 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018776 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018777
18778internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18779 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18780 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18781 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18782 integer or one of the special value :
18783 * head : The oldest inserted block
18784 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018785 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018786
18787internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18788 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18789 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18790 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18791 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18792
18793 * head : The oldest inserted block
18794 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018795 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018796
18797internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18798 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18799 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18800 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18801 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18802
18803 * head : The oldest inserted block
18804 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018805 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018806
18807internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18808 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18809 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18810 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18811 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18812
18813 * head : The oldest inserted block
18814 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018815 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018816
18817internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18818 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18819 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18820 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18821 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18822
18823 * head : The oldest inserted block
18824 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018825 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018826
18827internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18828 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18829 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18830 it returns false.
18831
18832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200188337.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018834---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018835
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018836Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18837every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018838order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018839
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018840ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18841---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018842FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018843HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018844HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18845HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018846HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18847HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18848HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18849HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18850LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018851METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018852METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018853METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18854METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18855METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18856METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018857METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018858METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018859RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018860REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018861TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018862WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18863---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018864
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188668. Logging
18867----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018868
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018869One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18870provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18871very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18872provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18873state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018874to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018875headers.
18876
18877In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18878about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18879send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18880
18881 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18882 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18883 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18884 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18885 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018886 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018887 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018888
18889The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18890allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18891as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18892while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18893real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18894delay.
18895
18896
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188978.1. Log levels
18898---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018899
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018900TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018901source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018902HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18903in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18904track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18905syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18906about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018907
18908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189098.2. Log formats
18910----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018911
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018912HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018913and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18914slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18915options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018916
18917 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18918 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18919 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18920 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18921 extents.
18922
18923 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18924 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18925 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18926 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18927 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18928
18929 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18930 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18931 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18932 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18933 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18934
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018935 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18936 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18937 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18938 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18939
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018940 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18941
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018942Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18943specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18944field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18945servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18946always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18947identifier.
18948
18949Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18950 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18951 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18952 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18953 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18954
18955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189568.2.1. Default log format
18957-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018958
18959This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18960as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18961format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18962
18963 Example :
18964 listen www
18965 mode http
18966 log global
18967 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18968
18969 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18970 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18971 (www/HTTP)
18972
18973 Field Format Extract from the example above
18974 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18975 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18976 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18977 4 'to' to
18978 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18979 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18980
18981Detailed fields description :
18982 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18983 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18984 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18985 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18986 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18987 and processed the connection.
18988 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18989
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018990In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18991"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18992connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18993
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018994It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18995will eventually disappear.
18996
18997
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189988.2.2. TCP log format
18999---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019000
19001The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19002is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19003information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19004counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19005emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19006environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19007the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19008sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019009specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19010not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19011fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19012marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019013
19014 Example :
19015 frontend fnt
19016 mode tcp
19017 option tcplog
19018 log global
19019 default_backend bck
19020
19021 backend bck
19022 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19023
19024 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19025 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19026 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19027
19028 Field Format Extract from the example above
19029 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19030 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19031 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19032 4 frontend_name fnt
19033 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19034 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19035 7 bytes_read* 212
19036 8 termination_state --
19037 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19038 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19039
19040Detailed fields description :
19041 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019042 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19043 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19044 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019045 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019046 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019047 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019048
19049 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019050 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19051 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19052 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019053
19054 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19055 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19056 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019057 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19058 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19059 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19060 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019061
19062 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19063 and processed the connection.
19064
19065 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19066 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19067 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19068 applications.
19069
19070 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19071 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19072 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19073 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19074 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19075
19076 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19077 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19078 See "Timers" below for more details.
19079
19080 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19081 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19082 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19083 "Timers" below for more details.
19084
19085 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019086 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019087 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19088 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19089 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19090 details.
19091
19092 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19093 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19094 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19095 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19096 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19097
19098 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19099 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19100 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19101 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19102 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19103 for more details.
19104
19105 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019106 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019107 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19108 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19109 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019110 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019111
19112 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19113 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19114 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19115 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19116 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19117 caused by a denial of service attack.
19118
19119 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19120 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19121 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19122 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19123 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19124 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19125 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19126 denial of service attack.
19127
19128 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19129 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19130 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19131 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19132 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19133 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19134 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19135 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19136 be processed than on other servers.
19137
19138 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19139 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19140 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19141 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19142 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19143 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19144 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19145 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19146 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19147 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19148 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19149 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19150 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19151
19152 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19153 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19154 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19155 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19156 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19157 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019158 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019159 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19160
19161 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19162 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19163 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19164 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19165 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19166 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019167 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019168 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19169 occurs.
19170
19171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191728.2.3. HTTP log format
19173----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019174
19175The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19176is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19177the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19178are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19179emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19180generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19181"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19182which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019183frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19184is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019185
19186Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19187slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19188with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19189
19190 Example :
19191 frontend http-in
19192 mode http
19193 option httplog
19194 log global
19195 default_backend bck
19196
19197 backend static
19198 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19199
19200 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19201 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19202 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019203 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019204
19205 Field Format Extract from the example above
19206 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
19207 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019208 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019209 4 frontend_name http-in
19210 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019211 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019212 7 status_code 200
19213 8 bytes_read* 2750
19214 9 captured_request_cookie -
19215 10 captured_response_cookie -
19216 11 termination_state ----
19217 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
19218 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19219 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
19220 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
19221 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019222
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019223Detailed fields description :
19224 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019225 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19226 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19227 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019228 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019229 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019230 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019231
19232 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019233 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19234 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19235 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019236
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019237 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
19238 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019239
19240 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19241 and processed the connection.
19242
19243 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19244 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19245 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
19246
19247 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19248 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19249 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19250 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
19251 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
19252 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
19253
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019254 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
19255 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
19256 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019257 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019258 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
19259 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019260 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
19261 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019262
19263 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19264 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019265 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019266
19267 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19268 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019269 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
19270 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019271
19272 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
19273 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
19274 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
19275 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
19276 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019277 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
19278 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019279
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019280 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
19281 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
19282 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
19283 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
19284 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
19285 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
19286 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019287 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019288
19289 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
19290 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
19291 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
19292
19293 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19294 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019295 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019296 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19297 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19298 overflowing.
19299
19300 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19301 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19302 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19303 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19304 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19305 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19306 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19307 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19308
19309 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19310 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19311 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19312 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19313 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19314 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19315 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19316 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19317
19318 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19319 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19320 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19321 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19322 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19323 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19324 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19325
19326 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019327 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019328 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19329 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19330 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019331 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019332 system.
19333
19334 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19335 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19336 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19337 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19338 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19339 caused by a denial of service attack.
19340
19341 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19342 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19343 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19344 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19345 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19346 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19347 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19348 denial of service attack.
19349
19350 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19351 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19352 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19353 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19354 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19355 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19356 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19357 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19358 processed than on other servers.
19359
19360 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19361 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19362 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19363 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19364 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19365 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19366 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19367 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19368 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19369 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19370 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19371 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19372 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19373
19374 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19375 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19376 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19377 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19378 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19379 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019380 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019381 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19382
19383 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19384 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19385 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19386 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19387 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19388 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019389 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019390 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19391 occurs.
19392
19393 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19394 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19395 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19396 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19397 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19398 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19399 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19400 cookies" below for more details.
19401
19402 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19403 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19404 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19405 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19406 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19407 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19408 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19409 and cookies" below for more details.
19410
19411 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19412 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19413 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19414 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19415 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19416 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19417 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19418 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19419
19420
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200194218.2.4. Custom log format
19422------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019423
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019424The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019425mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019426
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019427HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019428Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19429separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19430prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19431
19432Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19433variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019434("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019435
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019436If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019437as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019438less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19439the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19440
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019441Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19442"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19443delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19444preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019445
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019446Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19447'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19448https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19449such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19450
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019451Flags are :
19452 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019453 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019454 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19455 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019456
19457 Example:
19458
19459 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19460 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19461
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019462 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19463
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019464At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19465
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019466 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19467 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019468
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019469the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019470
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019471 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19472 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19473 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019474
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019475and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19476
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019477 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19478 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019479
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019480Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19481
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019482 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019483 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019484 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19485 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19486 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019487 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19488 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19489 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019490 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019491 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdebf9f0f942020-11-26 10:45:52 +000019492 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019493 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019494 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19495 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019496 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019497 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019498 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019499 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019500 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019501 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019502 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019503 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19504 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19505 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19506 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19507 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019508 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019509 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019510 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019511 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019512 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019513 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19514 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019515 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19516 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19517 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019518 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019519 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19520 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019521 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019522 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19523 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19524 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019525 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019526 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019527 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19528 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19529 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19530 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019531 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019532 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019533 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019534 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019535 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019536 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019537 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19538 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19539 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019540 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019541 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19542 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019543 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019544 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19545 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019546 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019547 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019548 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019549 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019550
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019551 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019552
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019553
195548.2.5. Error log format
19555-----------------------
19556
19557When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19558protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19559By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19560"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019561will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019562logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19563
19564The format looks like this :
19565
19566 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19567 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19568 Connection error during SSL handshake
19569
19570 Field Format Extract from the example above
19571 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19572 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19573 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19574 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19575 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19576
19577These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19578failures.
19579
19580
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195818.3. Advanced logging options
19582-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019583
19584Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19585just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19586options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19587for more information about their usage.
19588
19589
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195908.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19591------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019592
19593It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19594haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19595commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19596monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19597ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19598
19599 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19600 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19601 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19602 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19603
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020019604 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
19605 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019606
19607 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19608 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19609 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19610
19611
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196128.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19613----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019614
19615The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19616what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19617or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019618"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019619just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19620log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19621after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19622is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19623with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19624with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19625
19626
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196278.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19628------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019629
19630Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19631for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19632"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19633retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19634raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19635a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19636file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19637you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19638"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19639
19640
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196418.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19642--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019643
19644Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19645multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19646them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19647"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19648logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19649error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19650and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19651too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19652useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19653alternative.
19654
19655
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196568.4. Timing events
19657------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019658
19659Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19660reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19661the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19662frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019663mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19664addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19665
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019666Timings events in HTTP mode:
19667
19668 first request 2nd request
19669 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19670 t tr t tr ...
19671 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19672 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19673 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19674 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019675 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019676 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19677
19678Timings events in TCP mode:
19679
19680 TCP session
19681 |<----------------->|
19682 t t
19683 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19684 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19685 |<------ Tt ------->|
19686
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019687 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019688 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019689 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19690 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19691 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019692 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019693 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19694 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19695 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19696 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019697
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019698 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19699 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19700 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019701 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19702 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19703 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19704 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19705 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19706 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019707
19708 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19709 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19710 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19711 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19712 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19713 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19714 request typed by hand during a test.
19715
19716 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19717 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019718 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019719 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19720 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19721 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19722 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019723
19724 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19725 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19726 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19727 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19728 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19729
19730 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19731 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19732 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19733 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19734 connection never established.
19735
19736 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19737 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19738 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19739 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19740 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19741 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19742 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19743 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19744 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19745 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19746 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19747
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019748 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19749 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19750 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19751 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19752 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19753 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19754
19755 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19756
19757 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19758 "Ta" can never be negative.
19759
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019760 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19761 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019762 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19763 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019764 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019765
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019766 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019767
19768 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019769 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19770 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019771
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019772 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19773 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19774 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19775 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19776 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19777 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19778 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19779 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19780
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019781These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19782protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19783that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019784due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19785"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19786that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019787
19788Most common cases :
19789
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019790 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19791 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19792 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19793 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19794 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19795 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19796 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19797 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19798 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19799 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19800 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019801 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019802
19803 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19804 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19805 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19806 of ms on remote networks.
19807
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019808 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19809 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19810 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019811
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019812 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19813 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19814 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19815 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19816 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19817 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19818 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19819 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19820 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019821
19822Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19823
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019824 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019825 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019826 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019827
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019828 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019829 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19830 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19831
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019832 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019833 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19834 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19835 flags.
19836
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019837 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19838 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019839 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19840 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19841 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19842 the client connection was maintained open.
19843
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019844 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019845 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019846 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019847 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19848
19849
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198508.5. Session state at disconnection
19851-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019852
19853TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19854"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
198552-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19856each of which has a special meaning :
19857
19858 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19859 session to terminate :
19860
19861 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19862
19863 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19864 server explicitly refused it.
19865
19866 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19867 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19868 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19869 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019870 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019871
19872 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19873 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019874
19875 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19876 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19877 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19878 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19879 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19880
19881 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19882 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19883 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19884 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19885 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19886
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019887 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19888 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19889
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019890 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19891 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19892 backup connections when going up.
19893
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019894 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19895
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019896 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19897 send or receive data.
19898
19899 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19900 send or receive data.
19901
19902 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19903 with nothing left in the buffers.
19904
19905 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19906
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019907 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019908 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19909
19910 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19911 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19912 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19913 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19914 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19915
19916 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19917 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19918
19919 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19920 server (HTTP only).
19921
19922 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19923
19924 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19925 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19926 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19927
19928 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19929 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19930 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19931
19932 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19933
19934 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19935 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19936
19937 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19938 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19939 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19940
19941 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19942 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019943 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19944 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019945
19946 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19947 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19948 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19949 another server.
19950
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019951 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019952 server.
19953
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019954 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19955 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19956 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19957 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19958
19959 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19960 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19961 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19962 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19963
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019964 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19965 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19966 "use-server" rule).
19967
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019968 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19969
19970 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19971 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19972
19973 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19974
19975 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19976 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19977 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19978
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019979 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19980 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019981 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019982 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19983 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19984
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019985 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19986
19987 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19988 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19989
19990 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19991
19992 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19993
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019994The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19995was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019996helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19997starvation, attacks, etc...
19998
19999The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20000alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20001easier finding and understanding.
20002
20003 Flags Reason
20004
20005 -- Normal termination.
20006
20007 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20008 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20009 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20010 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20011
20012 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20013 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20014 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20015 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20016 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20017 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020018
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020019 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20020 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020021 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020022
20023 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20024 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20025 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20026
20027 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20028 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20029 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20030 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20031 the server takes too long to respond.
20032
20033 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20034 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20035 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20036 long a time to respond.
20037
20038 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20039 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20040 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20041 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020042 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20043 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020044
20045 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20046 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20047 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20048 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20049 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020050 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020051 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20052 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20053 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20054 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20055 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20056 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20057 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20058 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020059 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020060 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20061 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20062 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020063
20064 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20065 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020066 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20067 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20068 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20069 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020070
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020071 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20072 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20073
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020074 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020075 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20076 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020077 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020078 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20079 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20080
20081 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20082 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20083 503 or 504 here.
20084
20085 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20086 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20087 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20088 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20089 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20090
20091 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20092 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020093 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020094 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20095 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20096
20097 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20098 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20099 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20100 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20101 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20102 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20103 between haproxy and the server.
20104
20105 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20106 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20107 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20108 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20109 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20110 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20111 solution is to fix the application.
20112
20113 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20114 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20115 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20116 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20117 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20118 external attacks.
20119
20120 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombsdab4ba62021-01-07 21:24:41 -070020121 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020122 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020123 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20124 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20125
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020126 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20127 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20128 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020129 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020130 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020131
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020132 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20133 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20134 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20135 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020136 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20137 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20138 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20139 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20140 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020141
20142 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20143 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20144 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20145 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20146
20147 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20148 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20149 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20150 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20151
20152 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20153 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20154 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20155 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20156
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020157The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20158persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20159important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20160re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20161
20162 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20163
20164 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20165 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20166 set on a GET request.
20167
20168 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20169 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020170 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020171 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20172
20173 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20174 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20175 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20176
20177 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20178 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20179 already got a cookie.
20180
20181 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20182 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20183 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20184 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20185 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20186
20187 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20188 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20189 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20190
20191 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20192 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20193 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20194
20195 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20196 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20197
20198 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20199 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20200 then advertised in the response.
20201
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202038.6. Non-printable characters
20204-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020205
20206In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
20207consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
20208converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
20209prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
20210being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
20211escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
20212is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
20213'}' when logging headers.
20214
20215Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
20216issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
20217containing spaces is "User-Agent".
20218
20219Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
20220the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
20221performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
20222
20223
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202248.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
20225---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020226
20227Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
20228achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020229section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020230cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
20231the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
20232the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020233locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020234not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
20235user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
20236a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
20237wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
20238
20239 Examples :
20240 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
20241 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
20242
20243 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
20244 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
20245
20246
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202478.8. Capturing HTTP headers
20248---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020249
20250Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
20251proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
20252the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
20253server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
20254
20255Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
20256response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020257section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020258
20259It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020260time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
20261appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020262are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
20263and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
20264follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
20265request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
20266in the logs.
20267
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020268As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
20269frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
20270an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
20271
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020272 Example :
20273 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
20274 listen proxy-out
20275 mode http
20276 option httplog
20277 option logasap
20278 log global
20279 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
20280
20281 # log the name of the virtual server
20282 capture request header Host len 20
20283
20284 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
20285 capture request header Content-Length len 10
20286
20287 # log the beginning of the referrer
20288 capture request header Referer len 20
20289
20290 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20291 capture response header Server len 20
20292
20293 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20294 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20295
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020296 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020297 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20298
20299 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20300 capture response header Via len 20
20301
20302 # log the URL location during a redirection
20303 capture response header Location len 20
20304
20305 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20306 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20307 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20308 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20309 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20310
20311 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20312 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20313 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20314 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020315 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020316
20317 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20318 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20319 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20320 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20321 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020322 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020323
20324
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203258.9. Examples of logs
20326---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020327
20328These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20329them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20330reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20331
20332 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20333 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20334 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20335
20336 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20337 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20338
20339 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20340 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20341 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20342
20343 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20344 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20345
20346 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20347 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20348 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20349
20350 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020351 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020352 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20353 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20354
20355 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20356 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20357 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20358
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020359 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20360 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20361 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20362 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20363 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20364 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020365
20366 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020367 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020368
20369 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20370 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20371 Nothing was sent to any server.
20372
20373 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20374 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20375
20376 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20377 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020378 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020379 send a 408 return code to the client.
20380
20381 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20382 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20383
20384 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20385 5 seconds ("c----").
20386
20387 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20388 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020389 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020390
20391 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020392 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020393 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20394 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20395 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20396 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20397 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020398
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020399
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200204009. Supported filters
20401--------------------
20402
20403Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20404accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20405unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20406
20407See also : "filter"
20408
204099.1. Trace
20410----------
20411
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020412filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020413
20414 Arguments:
20415 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20416 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20417
20418 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
20419 the client and the server. By default, this filter
20420 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
20421 only parses a random amount of the available data.
20422
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020423 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020424 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20425 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20426 amount of the parsed data.
20427
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020428 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020429
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020430This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20431callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20432information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20433filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20434
20435Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20436tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20437a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20438
20439
204409.2. HTTP compression
20441---------------------
20442
20443filter compression
20444
20445The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20446keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020447when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20448fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20449done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20450explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20451filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20452listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20453order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020454
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020455See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20456 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020457
20458
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200204599.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20460--------------------------------------------
20461
20462filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20463
20464 Arguments :
20465
20466 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20467 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20468 parsed.
20469
20470 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20471 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20472 part must be placed in its own scope.
20473
20474The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20475external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020476streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020477exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20478also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20479
20480SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20481the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20482
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020483For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020484"doc/SPOE.txt".
20485
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100204869.4. Cache
20487----------
20488
20489filter cache <name>
20490
20491 Arguments :
20492
20493 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20494
20495The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20496"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020497cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020498other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20499case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20500is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20501filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020502listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20503order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020504
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020505See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20506 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20507
20508
205099.5. Fcgi-app
20510-------------
20511
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020512filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020513
20514 Arguments :
20515
20516 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20517
20518The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20519request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20520reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20521used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20522implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20523used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20524fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20525used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20526order.
20527
20528See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20529 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20530
20531
2053210. FastCGI applications
20533-------------------------
20534
20535HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20536feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20537the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20538FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20539servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20540FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20541backend.
20542
20543HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20544application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20545connection.
20546
2054710.1. Setup
20548-----------
20549
2055010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20551--------------------------
20552
20553fcgi-app <name>
20554 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20555 document root must be defined.
20556
20557acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20558 Declare or complete an access list.
20559
20560 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20561 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20562 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20563 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20564 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20565
20566docroot <path>
20567 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20568 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20569 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20570
20571index <script-name>
20572 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20573 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20574 is an optional setting.
20575
20576 Example :
20577 index index.php
20578
20579log-stderr global
20580log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagnerf2f5c4e2020-12-17 22:22:32 +010020581 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020582 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20583
20584 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20585 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20586
20587pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20588 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20589 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20590 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20591
20592 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20593 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20594 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20595 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20596
20597 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20598 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20599
20600path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020601 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020602 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20603 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20604 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20605 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20606 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20607 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20608 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020609
20610 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020611 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020612 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20613 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20614 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20615 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020616
20617 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020618 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20619 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020620
20621option get-values
20622no option get-values
20623 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20624
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020625 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020626 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20627
20628 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20629 application will accept.
20630
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020631 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20632 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020633
20634 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020635 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020636 option is disabled.
20637
20638 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20639 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20640 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20641 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20642 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20643 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20644
20645option keep-conn
20646no option keep-conn
20647 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20648 sending a response.
20649
20650 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20651 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20652
20653option max-reqs <reqs>
20654 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20655 accept.
20656
20657 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20658 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20659 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20660 to 1.
20661
20662option mpxs-conns
20663no option mpxs-conns
20664 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20665
20666 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20667 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20668
20669set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20670 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20671 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20672 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20673 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20674
20675 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20676 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20677 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20678
20679 Example :
20680 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20681 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20682
20683 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20684
20685
2068610.1.2. Proxy section
20687---------------------
20688
20689use-fcgi-app <name>
20690 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20691
20692 Arguments :
20693 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20694
20695 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20696 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20697 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20698 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20699 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20700
20701 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20702 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20703 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20704 application are evaluated.
20705
20706
2070710.1.3. Example
20708---------------
20709
20710 frontend front-http
20711 mode http
20712 bind *:80
20713 bind *:
20714
20715 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20716 default_backend back-static
20717
20718 backend back-static
20719 mode http
20720 server www A.B.C.D:80
20721
20722 backend back-dynamic
20723 mode http
20724 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20725 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20726
20727 fcgi-app php-fpm
20728 log-stderr global
20729 option keep-conn
20730
20731 docroot /var/www/my-app
20732 index index.php
20733 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20734
20735
2073610.2. Default parameters
20737------------------------
20738
20739A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20740the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020741script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020742applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20743
20744 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20745 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20746 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20747 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20748 | | |
20749 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20750 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20751 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20752 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20753 | | application. |
20754 | | |
20755 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20756 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20757 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20758 | | |
20759 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20760 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20761 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20762 | | the application's configuration. |
20763 | | |
20764 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20765 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20766 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20767 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20768 | | |
20769 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20770 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20771 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20772 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20773 | | be defined. |
20774 | | |
20775 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20776 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20777 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20778 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20779 | | is not set too. |
20780 | | |
20781 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20782 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20783 | | set. |
20784 | | |
20785 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20786 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20787 | | the request. |
20788 | | |
20789 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20790 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20791 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20792 | | |
20793 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20794 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20795 | | script to process the request. |
20796 | | |
20797 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20798 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20799 | | |
20800 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20801 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20802 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20803 | | |
20804 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20805 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20806 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20807 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20808 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20809 | | |
20810 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20811 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20812 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20813 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20814 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20815 | | side. |
20816 | | |
20817 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20818 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20819 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20820 | | connected to. |
20821 | | |
20822 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20823 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20824 | | |
20825 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20826 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20827 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20828 | | |
20829 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20830
20831
2083210.3. Limitations
20833------------------
20834
20835The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20836way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20837during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20838establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20839application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20840or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20841message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20842these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20843and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20844
20845Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20846request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20847requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20848
20849About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20850into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20851fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20852"http-request" ones.
20853
20854Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20855FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20856processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20857must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20858here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020859
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020860/*
20861 * Local variables:
20862 * fill-column: 79
20863 * End:
20864 */